1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
44 #include "libiberty.h"
45 #include "safe-ctype.h"
46 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
52 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
53 static bfd_boolean
assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd
*, struct bfd_link_info
*);
54 static bfd_boolean
swap_out_syms (bfd
*, struct elf_strtab_hash
**, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean
elf_parse_notes (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, size_t size
,
56 file_ptr offset
, size_t align
);
58 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
59 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
60 need to move into elfcode.h. */
62 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
65 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd
*abfd
,
66 const Elf_External_Verdef
*src
,
67 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*dst
)
69 dst
->vd_version
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_version
);
70 dst
->vd_flags
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_flags
);
71 dst
->vd_ndx
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_ndx
);
72 dst
->vd_cnt
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_cnt
);
73 dst
->vd_hash
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_hash
);
74 dst
->vd_aux
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_aux
);
75 dst
->vd_next
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_next
);
78 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
81 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd
*abfd
,
82 const Elf_Internal_Verdef
*src
,
83 Elf_External_Verdef
*dst
)
85 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_version
, dst
->vd_version
);
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_flags
, dst
->vd_flags
);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_ndx
, dst
->vd_ndx
);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vd_cnt
, dst
->vd_cnt
);
89 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_hash
, dst
->vd_hash
);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_aux
, dst
->vd_aux
);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vd_next
, dst
->vd_next
);
94 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
97 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd
*abfd
,
98 const Elf_External_Verdaux
*src
,
99 Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*dst
)
101 dst
->vda_name
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vda_name
);
102 dst
->vda_next
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vda_next
);
105 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
108 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd
*abfd
,
109 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*src
,
110 Elf_External_Verdaux
*dst
)
112 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vda_name
, dst
->vda_name
);
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vda_next
, dst
->vda_next
);
116 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
119 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd
*abfd
,
120 const Elf_External_Verneed
*src
,
121 Elf_Internal_Verneed
*dst
)
123 dst
->vn_version
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vn_version
);
124 dst
->vn_cnt
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vn_cnt
);
125 dst
->vn_file
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_file
);
126 dst
->vn_aux
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_aux
);
127 dst
->vn_next
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_next
);
130 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
133 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd
*abfd
,
134 const Elf_Internal_Verneed
*src
,
135 Elf_External_Verneed
*dst
)
137 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vn_version
, dst
->vn_version
);
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vn_cnt
, dst
->vn_cnt
);
139 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_file
, dst
->vn_file
);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_aux
, dst
->vn_aux
);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vn_next
, dst
->vn_next
);
144 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
147 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd
*abfd
,
148 const Elf_External_Vernaux
*src
,
149 Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*dst
)
151 dst
->vna_hash
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_hash
);
152 dst
->vna_flags
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vna_flags
);
153 dst
->vna_other
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vna_other
);
154 dst
->vna_name
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_name
);
155 dst
->vna_next
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_next
);
158 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
161 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd
*abfd
,
162 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*src
,
163 Elf_External_Vernaux
*dst
)
165 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_hash
, dst
->vna_hash
);
166 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vna_flags
, dst
->vna_flags
);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vna_other
, dst
->vna_other
);
168 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_name
, dst
->vna_name
);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, src
->vna_next
, dst
->vna_next
);
172 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
175 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd
*abfd
,
176 const Elf_External_Versym
*src
,
177 Elf_Internal_Versym
*dst
)
179 dst
->vs_vers
= H_GET_16 (abfd
, src
->vs_vers
);
182 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
185 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd
*abfd
,
186 const Elf_Internal_Versym
*src
,
187 Elf_External_Versym
*dst
)
189 H_PUT_16 (abfd
, src
->vs_vers
, dst
->vs_vers
);
192 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
193 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
196 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg
)
198 const unsigned char *name
= (const unsigned char *) namearg
;
203 while ((ch
= *name
++) != '\0')
206 if ((g
= (h
& 0xf0000000)) != 0)
209 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
210 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
214 return h
& 0xffffffff;
217 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
218 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
221 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg
)
223 const unsigned char *name
= (const unsigned char *) namearg
;
224 unsigned long h
= 5381;
227 while ((ch
= *name
++) != '\0')
228 h
= (h
<< 5) + h
+ ch
;
229 return h
& 0xffffffff;
232 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
233 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
235 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd
*abfd
,
237 enum elf_target_id object_id
)
239 BFD_ASSERT (object_size
>= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata
));
240 abfd
->tdata
.any
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, object_size
);
241 if (abfd
->tdata
.any
== NULL
)
244 elf_object_id (abfd
) = object_id
;
245 if (abfd
->direction
!= read_direction
)
247 struct output_elf_obj_tdata
*o
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof *o
);
250 elf_tdata (abfd
)->o
= o
;
251 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = (bfd_size_type
) -1;
258 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd
*abfd
)
260 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
261 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd
, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata
),
266 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd
*abfd
)
268 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
269 if (!abfd
->xvec
->_bfd_set_format
[(int) bfd_object
] (abfd
))
271 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
));
272 return elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
!= NULL
;
276 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd
*abfd
, unsigned int shindex
)
278 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**i_shdrp
;
279 bfd_byte
*shstrtab
= NULL
;
281 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize
;
283 i_shdrp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
285 || shindex
>= elf_numsections (abfd
)
286 || i_shdrp
[shindex
] == 0)
289 shstrtab
= i_shdrp
[shindex
]->contents
;
290 if (shstrtab
== NULL
)
292 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
293 offset
= i_shdrp
[shindex
]->sh_offset
;
294 shstrtabsize
= i_shdrp
[shindex
]->sh_size
;
296 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
297 in case the string table is not terminated. */
298 if (shstrtabsize
+ 1 <= 1
299 || shstrtabsize
> bfd_get_file_size (abfd
)
300 || bfd_seek (abfd
, offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
301 || (shstrtab
= (bfd_byte
*) bfd_alloc (abfd
, shstrtabsize
+ 1)) == NULL
)
303 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab
, shstrtabsize
, abfd
) != shstrtabsize
)
305 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call
)
306 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated
);
307 bfd_release (abfd
, shstrtab
);
309 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
310 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
311 the string table over and over. */
312 i_shdrp
[shindex
]->sh_size
= 0;
315 shstrtab
[shstrtabsize
] = '\0';
316 i_shdrp
[shindex
]->contents
= shstrtab
;
318 return (char *) shstrtab
;
322 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd
*abfd
,
323 unsigned int shindex
,
324 unsigned int strindex
)
326 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
331 if (elf_elfsections (abfd
) == NULL
|| shindex
>= elf_numsections (abfd
))
334 hdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
];
336 if (hdr
->contents
== NULL
)
338 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_STRTAB
&& hdr
->sh_type
< SHT_LOOS
)
340 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
341 /* xgettext:c-format */
342 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
343 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
348 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd
, shindex
) == NULL
)
353 /* PR 24273: The string section's contents may have already
354 been loaded elsewhere, eg because a corrupt file has the
355 string section index in the ELF header pointing at a group
356 section. So be paranoid, and test that the last byte of
357 the section is zero. */
358 if (hdr
->sh_size
== 0 || hdr
->contents
[hdr
->sh_size
- 1] != 0)
362 if (strindex
>= hdr
->sh_size
)
364 unsigned int shstrndx
= elf_elfheader(abfd
)->e_shstrndx
;
366 /* xgettext:c-format */
367 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64
" for section `%s'"),
368 abfd
, strindex
, (uint64_t) hdr
->sh_size
,
369 (shindex
== shstrndx
&& strindex
== hdr
->sh_name
371 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, shstrndx
, hdr
->sh_name
)));
375 return ((char *) hdr
->contents
) + strindex
;
378 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
379 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
380 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
381 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
382 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
383 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
384 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
387 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd
*ibfd
,
388 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
,
391 Elf_Internal_Sym
*intsym_buf
,
393 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
*extshndx_buf
)
395 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shndx_hdr
;
397 const bfd_byte
*esym
;
398 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
*alloc_extshndx
;
399 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
*shndx
;
400 Elf_Internal_Sym
*alloc_intsym
;
401 Elf_Internal_Sym
*isym
;
402 Elf_Internal_Sym
*isymend
;
403 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
408 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
414 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
416 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd
) != NULL
)
418 elf_section_list
* entry
;
419 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**sections
= elf_elfsections (ibfd
);
421 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
422 for (entry
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd
); entry
!= NULL
; entry
= entry
->next
)
425 if (entry
->hdr
.sh_link
>= elf_numsections (ibfd
))
428 if (sections
[entry
->hdr
.sh_link
] == symtab_hdr
)
430 shndx_hdr
= & entry
->hdr
;
435 if (shndx_hdr
== NULL
)
437 if (symtab_hdr
== & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd
))
438 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
439 shndx_hdr
= & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd
)->hdr
;
440 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
441 the index table will not be needed. */
445 /* Read the symbols. */
447 alloc_extshndx
= NULL
;
449 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (ibfd
);
450 extsym_size
= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
;
451 amt
= (bfd_size_type
) symcount
* extsym_size
;
452 pos
= symtab_hdr
->sh_offset
+ symoffset
* extsym_size
;
453 if (extsym_buf
== NULL
)
455 alloc_ext
= bfd_malloc2 (symcount
, extsym_size
);
456 extsym_buf
= alloc_ext
;
458 if (extsym_buf
== NULL
459 || bfd_seek (ibfd
, pos
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
460 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf
, amt
, ibfd
) != amt
)
466 if (shndx_hdr
== NULL
|| shndx_hdr
->sh_size
== 0)
470 amt
= (bfd_size_type
) symcount
* sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
);
471 pos
= shndx_hdr
->sh_offset
+ symoffset
* sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
);
472 if (extshndx_buf
== NULL
)
474 alloc_extshndx
= (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
*)
475 bfd_malloc2 (symcount
, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
));
476 extshndx_buf
= alloc_extshndx
;
478 if (extshndx_buf
== NULL
479 || bfd_seek (ibfd
, pos
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
480 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf
, amt
, ibfd
) != amt
)
487 if (intsym_buf
== NULL
)
489 alloc_intsym
= (Elf_Internal_Sym
*)
490 bfd_malloc2 (symcount
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym
));
491 intsym_buf
= alloc_intsym
;
492 if (intsym_buf
== NULL
)
496 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
497 isymend
= intsym_buf
+ symcount
;
498 for (esym
= (const bfd_byte
*) extsym_buf
, isym
= intsym_buf
,
499 shndx
= extshndx_buf
;
501 esym
+= extsym_size
, isym
++, shndx
= shndx
!= NULL
? shndx
+ 1 : NULL
)
502 if (!(*bed
->s
->swap_symbol_in
) (ibfd
, esym
, shndx
, isym
))
504 symoffset
+= (esym
- (bfd_byte
*) extsym_buf
) / extsym_size
;
505 /* xgettext:c-format */
506 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
507 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
508 ibfd
, (unsigned long) symoffset
);
509 if (alloc_intsym
!= NULL
)
516 if (alloc_ext
!= NULL
)
518 if (alloc_extshndx
!= NULL
)
519 free (alloc_extshndx
);
524 /* Look up a symbol name. */
526 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd
*abfd
,
527 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
,
528 Elf_Internal_Sym
*isym
,
532 unsigned int iname
= isym
->st_name
;
533 unsigned int shindex
= symtab_hdr
->sh_link
;
535 if (iname
== 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym
->st_info
) == STT_SECTION
536 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
537 && isym
->st_shndx
< elf_numsections (abfd
))
539 iname
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[isym
->st_shndx
]->sh_name
;
540 shindex
= elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_shstrndx
;
543 name
= bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, shindex
, iname
);
546 else if (sym_sec
&& *name
== '\0')
547 name
= bfd_section_name (sym_sec
);
552 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
553 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
556 typedef union elf_internal_group
{
557 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
;
559 } Elf_Internal_Group
;
561 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
562 signature just a string? */
565 group_signature (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Shdr
*ghdr
)
567 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
568 unsigned char esym
[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym
)];
569 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx
;
570 Elf_Internal_Sym isym
;
572 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
573 that it is a symbol table section. */
574 if (ghdr
->sh_link
>= elf_numsections (abfd
))
576 hdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
) [ghdr
->sh_link
];
577 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_SYMTAB
578 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, ghdr
->sh_link
))
581 /* Go read the symbol. */
582 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
;
583 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd
, hdr
, 1, ghdr
->sh_info
,
584 &isym
, esym
, &eshndx
) == NULL
)
587 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd
, hdr
, &isym
, NULL
);
590 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
593 setup_group (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
, asection
*newsect
)
595 unsigned int num_group
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
;
597 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
598 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
601 unsigned int i
, shnum
;
603 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
604 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
605 shnum
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
608 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
609 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
610 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
611 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
612 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
614 for (i
= 0; i
< shnum
; i
++)
616 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
618 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr
, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE
))
624 num_group
= (unsigned) -1;
625 elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
= num_group
;
626 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
= NULL
;
630 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
631 so we can find them quickly. */
634 elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
= num_group
;
635 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
= (Elf_Internal_Shdr
**)
636 bfd_alloc2 (abfd
, num_group
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*));
637 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
== NULL
)
639 memset (elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
, 0,
640 num_group
* sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*));
643 for (i
= 0; i
< shnum
; i
++)
645 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
647 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr
, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE
))
650 Elf_Internal_Group
*dest
;
652 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
654 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, i
))
657 /* Add to list of sections. */
658 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
[num_group
] = shdr
;
661 /* Read the raw contents. */
662 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest
) >= 4);
663 amt
= shdr
->sh_size
* sizeof (*dest
) / 4;
664 shdr
->contents
= (unsigned char *)
665 bfd_alloc2 (abfd
, shdr
->sh_size
, sizeof (*dest
) / 4);
666 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
667 if (shdr
->contents
== NULL
)
670 /* xgettext:c-format */
671 (_("%pB: corrupt size field in group section"
672 " header: %#" PRIx64
),
673 abfd
, (uint64_t) shdr
->sh_size
);
674 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
679 memset (shdr
->contents
, 0, amt
);
681 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, shdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
682 || (bfd_bread (shdr
->contents
, shdr
->sh_size
, abfd
)
686 /* xgettext:c-format */
687 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
688 " header: %#" PRIx64
""),
689 abfd
, (uint64_t) shdr
->sh_size
);
690 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
692 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
693 partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
694 contents to be used. */
695 memset (shdr
->contents
, 0, amt
);
699 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
700 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
701 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
703 src
= shdr
->contents
+ shdr
->sh_size
;
704 dest
= (Elf_Internal_Group
*) (shdr
->contents
+ amt
);
712 idx
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, src
);
713 if (src
== shdr
->contents
)
716 if (shdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
&& (idx
& GRP_COMDAT
))
717 shdr
->bfd_section
->flags
718 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE
| SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD
;
723 dest
->shdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[idx
];
724 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
725 section group should be marked with
726 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
727 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
729 dest
->shdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_GROUP
;
732 || dest
->shdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GROUP
)
735 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
743 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
744 if (num_group
!= (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
)
746 elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
= num_group
;
748 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
751 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
= NULL
;
752 elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
= num_group
= -1;
754 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd
);
755 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
761 if (num_group
!= (unsigned) -1)
763 unsigned int search_offset
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_search_offset
;
766 for (j
= 0; j
< num_group
; j
++)
768 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
769 unsigned i
= (j
+ search_offset
) % num_group
;
771 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
[i
];
772 Elf_Internal_Group
*idx
;
778 idx
= (Elf_Internal_Group
*) shdr
->contents
;
779 if (idx
== NULL
|| shdr
->sh_size
< 4)
781 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
782 /* xgettext:c-format */
783 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
784 abfd
, shdr
->bfd_section
);
785 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
[i
] = NULL
;
786 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
789 n_elt
= shdr
->sh_size
/ 4;
791 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
792 section is a member. */
794 if ((++idx
)->shdr
== hdr
)
798 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
799 other members to see if any others are linked via
801 idx
= (Elf_Internal_Group
*) shdr
->contents
;
802 n_elt
= shdr
->sh_size
/ 4;
804 if ((++idx
)->shdr
!= NULL
805 && (s
= idx
->shdr
->bfd_section
) != NULL
806 && elf_next_in_group (s
) != NULL
)
810 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
811 insert current section in circular list. */
812 elf_group_name (newsect
) = elf_group_name (s
);
813 elf_next_in_group (newsect
) = elf_next_in_group (s
);
814 elf_next_in_group (s
) = newsect
;
820 gname
= group_signature (abfd
, shdr
);
823 elf_group_name (newsect
) = gname
;
825 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
826 elf_next_in_group (newsect
) = newsect
;
829 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
831 if (shdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
)
832 elf_next_in_group (shdr
->bfd_section
) = newsect
;
834 elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_search_offset
= i
;
841 if (elf_group_name (newsect
) == NULL
)
843 /* xgettext:c-format */
844 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
852 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd
*abfd
)
855 unsigned int num_group
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->num_group
;
856 bfd_boolean result
= TRUE
;
859 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
860 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
862 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
= &elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
;
863 if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_LINK_ORDER
) != 0)
865 unsigned int elfsec
= this_hdr
->sh_link
;
866 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
867 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
868 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
871 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
872 if (bed
->link_order_error_handler
)
873 bed
->link_order_error_handler
874 /* xgettext:c-format */
875 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
880 asection
*linksec
= NULL
;
882 if (elfsec
< elf_numsections (abfd
))
884 this_hdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elfsec
];
885 linksec
= this_hdr
->bfd_section
;
889 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
890 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
894 /* xgettext:c-format */
895 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
896 s
->owner
, elfsec
, s
);
900 elf_linked_to_section (s
) = linksec
;
903 else if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GROUP
904 && elf_next_in_group (s
) == NULL
)
907 /* xgettext:c-format */
908 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
909 abfd
, elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
);
914 /* Process section groups. */
915 if (num_group
== (unsigned) -1)
918 for (i
= 0; i
< num_group
; i
++)
920 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->group_sect_ptr
[i
];
921 Elf_Internal_Group
*idx
;
924 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
925 if (shdr
== NULL
|| shdr
->bfd_section
== NULL
|| shdr
->contents
== NULL
)
928 /* xgettext:c-format */
929 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
935 idx
= (Elf_Internal_Group
*) shdr
->contents
;
936 n_elt
= shdr
->sh_size
/ 4;
942 if (idx
->shdr
== NULL
)
944 else if (idx
->shdr
->bfd_section
)
945 elf_sec_group (idx
->shdr
->bfd_section
) = shdr
->bfd_section
;
946 else if (idx
->shdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_RELA
947 && idx
->shdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_REL
)
949 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
951 /* xgettext:c-format */
952 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
955 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
,
956 (elf_elfheader (abfd
)
969 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, const asection
*sec
)
971 return elf_next_in_group (sec
) != NULL
;
975 bfd_elf_group_name (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, const asection
*sec
)
977 if (elf_sec_group (sec
) != NULL
)
978 return elf_group_name (sec
);
983 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd
*abfd
, const char *name
)
985 unsigned int len
= strlen (name
);
986 char *new_name
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
+ 2);
987 if (new_name
== NULL
)
991 memcpy (new_name
+ 2, name
+ 1, len
);
996 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd
*abfd
, const char *name
)
998 unsigned int len
= strlen (name
);
999 char *new_name
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
1000 if (new_name
== NULL
)
1003 memcpy (new_name
+ 1, name
+ 2, len
- 1);
1007 /* This a copy of lto_section defined in GCC (lto-streamer.h). */
1011 int16_t major_version
;
1012 int16_t minor_version
;
1013 unsigned char slim_object
;
1015 /* Flags is a private field that is not defined publicly. */
1019 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
1020 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
1023 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd
*abfd
,
1024 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
,
1030 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
1032 if (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
)
1035 newsect
= bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd
, name
);
1036 if (newsect
== NULL
)
1039 hdr
->bfd_section
= newsect
;
1040 elf_section_data (newsect
)->this_hdr
= *hdr
;
1041 elf_section_data (newsect
)->this_idx
= shindex
;
1043 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1044 elf_section_type (newsect
) = hdr
->sh_type
;
1045 elf_section_flags (newsect
) = hdr
->sh_flags
;
1047 newsect
->filepos
= hdr
->sh_offset
;
1049 if (!bfd_set_section_vma (newsect
, hdr
->sh_addr
)
1050 || !bfd_set_section_size (newsect
, hdr
->sh_size
)
1051 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (newsect
, bfd_log2 (hdr
->sh_addralign
)))
1054 flags
= SEC_NO_FLAGS
;
1055 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
1056 flags
|= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
;
1057 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GROUP
)
1059 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
1062 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
1065 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_WRITE
) == 0)
1066 flags
|= SEC_READONLY
;
1067 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_EXECINSTR
) != 0)
1069 else if ((flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0)
1071 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_MERGE
) != 0)
1074 newsect
->entsize
= hdr
->sh_entsize
;
1076 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_STRINGS
) != 0)
1077 flags
|= SEC_STRINGS
;
1078 if (hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
)
1079 if (!setup_group (abfd
, hdr
, newsect
))
1081 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) != 0)
1082 flags
|= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
;
1083 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_EXCLUDE
) != 0)
1084 flags
|= SEC_EXCLUDE
;
1086 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
])
1088 /* FIXME: We should not recognize SHF_GNU_MBIND for ELFOSABI_NONE,
1089 but binutils as of 2019-07-23 did not set the EI_OSABI header
1093 case ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
:
1094 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GNU_MBIND
) != 0)
1095 elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
|= elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
;
1099 if ((flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) == 0)
1101 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1102 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1103 if (name
[0] == '.')
1105 if (strncmp (name
, ".debug", 6) == 0
1106 || strncmp (name
, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", 17) == 0
1107 || strncmp (name
, ".zdebug", 7) == 0)
1108 flags
|= SEC_DEBUGGING
| SEC_ELF_OCTETS
;
1109 else if (strncmp (name
, GNU_BUILD_ATTRS_SECTION_NAME
, 21) == 0
1110 || strncmp (name
, ".note.gnu", 9) == 0)
1111 flags
|= SEC_ELF_OCTETS
;
1112 else if (strncmp (name
, ".line", 5) == 0
1113 || strncmp (name
, ".stab", 5) == 0
1114 || strcmp (name
, ".gdb_index") == 0)
1115 flags
|= SEC_DEBUGGING
;
1119 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1120 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1121 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1122 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1123 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1124 all but one of the sections. */
1125 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name
, ".gnu.linkonce")
1126 && elf_next_in_group (newsect
) == NULL
)
1127 flags
|= SEC_LINK_ONCE
| SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD
;
1129 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
1130 if (bed
->elf_backend_section_flags
)
1131 if (! bed
->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags
, hdr
))
1134 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (newsect
, flags
))
1137 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1138 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1139 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1140 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOTE
)
1144 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd
, newsect
, &contents
))
1147 elf_parse_notes (abfd
, (char *) contents
, hdr
->sh_size
,
1148 hdr
->sh_offset
, hdr
->sh_addralign
);
1152 if ((flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
1154 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*phdr
;
1155 unsigned int i
, nload
;
1157 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1158 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1159 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1160 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1161 phdr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
1162 for (nload
= 0, i
= 0; i
< elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
; i
++, phdr
++)
1163 if (phdr
->p_paddr
!= 0)
1165 else if (phdr
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& phdr
->p_memsz
!= 0)
1167 if (i
>= elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
&& nload
> 1)
1170 phdr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
1171 for (i
= 0; i
< elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
; i
++, phdr
++)
1173 if (((phdr
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
1174 && (hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) == 0)
1175 || phdr
->p_type
== PT_TLS
)
1176 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr
, phdr
))
1178 if ((flags
& SEC_LOAD
) == 0)
1179 newsect
->lma
= (phdr
->p_paddr
1180 + hdr
->sh_addr
- phdr
->p_vaddr
);
1182 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1183 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1184 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1185 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1186 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1187 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1188 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1189 newsect
->lma
= (phdr
->p_paddr
1190 + hdr
->sh_offset
- phdr
->p_offset
);
1192 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1193 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1194 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1195 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1196 if (hdr
->sh_addr
>= phdr
->p_vaddr
1197 && (hdr
->sh_addr
+ hdr
->sh_size
1198 <= phdr
->p_vaddr
+ phdr
->p_memsz
))
1204 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1205 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1206 if ((flags
& SEC_DEBUGGING
)
1207 && ((name
[1] == 'd' && name
[6] == '_')
1208 || (name
[1] == 'z' && name
[7] == '_')))
1210 enum { nothing
, compress
, decompress
} action
= nothing
;
1211 int compression_header_size
;
1212 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size
;
1213 unsigned int uncompressed_align_power
;
1214 bfd_boolean compressed
1215 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd
, newsect
,
1216 &compression_header_size
,
1218 &uncompressed_align_power
);
1221 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1222 if ((abfd
->flags
& BFD_DECOMPRESS
))
1223 action
= decompress
;
1226 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1227 section. Check if we should compress. */
1228 if (action
== nothing
)
1230 if (newsect
->size
!= 0
1231 && (abfd
->flags
& BFD_COMPRESS
)
1232 && compression_header_size
>= 0
1233 && uncompressed_size
> 0
1235 || ((compression_header_size
> 0)
1236 != ((abfd
->flags
& BFD_COMPRESS_GABI
) != 0))))
1242 if (action
== compress
)
1244 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd
, newsect
))
1247 /* xgettext:c-format */
1248 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1255 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd
, newsect
))
1258 /* xgettext:c-format */
1259 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1265 if (abfd
->is_linker_input
)
1268 && (action
== decompress
1269 || (action
== compress
1270 && (abfd
->flags
& BFD_COMPRESS_GABI
) != 0)))
1272 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1273 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1275 char *new_name
= convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd
, name
);
1276 if (new_name
== NULL
)
1278 bfd_rename_section (newsect
, new_name
);
1282 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1283 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1284 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_ELF_RENAME
;
1287 /* GCC uses .gnu.lto_.lto.<some_hash> as a LTO bytecode information
1289 const char *lto_section_name
= ".gnu.lto_.lto.";
1290 if (strncmp (name
, lto_section_name
, strlen (lto_section_name
)) == 0)
1292 struct lto_section lsection
;
1293 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd
, newsect
, &lsection
, 0,
1294 sizeof (struct lto_section
)))
1295 abfd
->lto_slim_object
= lsection
.slim_object
;
1301 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names
[] =
1303 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1304 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1305 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1308 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1309 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1310 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1311 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1312 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1313 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1314 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1315 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1316 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1318 bfd_reloc_status_type
1319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
1320 arelent
*reloc_entry
,
1322 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
1323 asection
*input_section
,
1325 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
1327 if (output_bfd
!= NULL
1328 && (symbol
->flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
) == 0
1329 && (! reloc_entry
->howto
->partial_inplace
1330 || reloc_entry
->addend
== 0))
1332 reloc_entry
->address
+= input_section
->output_offset
;
1333 return bfd_reloc_ok
;
1336 return bfd_reloc_continue
;
1339 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1340 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1341 should be the same. */
1344 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* a
,
1345 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* b
)
1347 if (a
->sh_type
!= b
->sh_type
1348 || ((a
->sh_flags
^ b
->sh_flags
) & ~SHF_INFO_LINK
) != 0
1349 || a
->sh_addralign
!= b
->sh_addralign
1350 || a
->sh_entsize
!= b
->sh_entsize
)
1352 if (a
->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB
1353 || a
->sh_type
== SHT_STRTAB
)
1355 return a
->sh_size
== b
->sh_size
;
1358 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1359 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1360 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1361 to be the correct section. */
1364 find_link (const bfd
*obfd
, const Elf_Internal_Shdr
*iheader
,
1365 const unsigned int hint
)
1367 Elf_Internal_Shdr
** oheaders
= elf_elfsections (obfd
);
1370 BFD_ASSERT (iheader
!= NULL
);
1372 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1373 if (hint
< elf_numsections (obfd
)
1374 && oheaders
[hint
] != NULL
1375 && section_match (oheaders
[hint
], iheader
))
1378 for (i
= 1; i
< elf_numsections (obfd
); i
++)
1380 Elf_Internal_Shdr
* oheader
= oheaders
[i
];
1382 if (oheader
== NULL
)
1384 if (section_match (oheader
, iheader
))
1385 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1386 multiple matches ? */
1393 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1394 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1395 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1398 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd
*ibfd
,
1400 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
*iheader
,
1401 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*oheader
,
1402 const unsigned int secnum
)
1404 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (obfd
);
1405 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
**iheaders
= (const Elf_Internal_Shdr
**) elf_elfsections (ibfd
);
1406 bfd_boolean changed
= FALSE
;
1407 unsigned int sh_link
;
1409 if (oheader
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
)
1411 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1412 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1413 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1414 matched up with the original.
1416 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1417 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1418 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1419 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1420 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1421 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1422 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1423 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1424 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1425 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1426 without any contents. */
1427 if (oheader
->sh_link
== 0)
1428 oheader
->sh_link
= iheader
->sh_link
;
1429 if (oheader
->sh_info
== 0)
1430 oheader
->sh_info
= iheader
->sh_info
;
1434 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1435 if (bed
->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
!= NULL
1436 && bed
->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1437 (ibfd
, obfd
, iheader
, oheader
))
1440 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1441 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1442 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1443 in the input bfd. */
1444 if (iheader
->sh_link
!= SHN_UNDEF
)
1446 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1447 if (iheader
->sh_link
>= elf_numsections (ibfd
))
1450 /* xgettext:c-format */
1451 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1452 ibfd
, iheader
->sh_link
, secnum
);
1456 sh_link
= find_link (obfd
, iheaders
[iheader
->sh_link
], iheader
->sh_link
);
1457 if (sh_link
!= SHN_UNDEF
)
1459 oheader
->sh_link
= sh_link
;
1463 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1464 if we could not find a match ? */
1466 /* xgettext:c-format */
1467 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd
, secnum
);
1470 if (iheader
->sh_info
)
1472 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1473 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1475 if (iheader
->sh_flags
& SHF_INFO_LINK
)
1477 sh_link
= find_link (obfd
, iheaders
[iheader
->sh_info
],
1479 if (sh_link
!= SHN_UNDEF
)
1480 oheader
->sh_flags
|= SHF_INFO_LINK
;
1483 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1484 sh_link
= iheader
->sh_info
;
1486 if (sh_link
!= SHN_UNDEF
)
1488 oheader
->sh_info
= sh_link
;
1493 /* xgettext:c-format */
1494 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd
, secnum
);
1500 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1504 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
1506 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
**iheaders
= (const Elf_Internal_Shdr
**) elf_elfsections (ibfd
);
1507 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**oheaders
= elf_elfsections (obfd
);
1508 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
1511 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1512 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
1515 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd
))
1517 elf_elfheader (obfd
)->e_flags
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_flags
;
1518 elf_flags_init (obfd
) = TRUE
;
1521 elf_gp (obfd
) = elf_gp (ibfd
);
1523 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1524 elf_elfheader (obfd
)->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] =
1525 elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
];
1527 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1528 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_ident
[EI_ABIVERSION
])
1529 elf_elfheader (obfd
)->e_ident
[EI_ABIVERSION
]
1530 = elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_ident
[EI_ABIVERSION
];
1532 /* Copy object attributes. */
1533 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd
, obfd
);
1535 if (iheaders
== NULL
|| oheaders
== NULL
)
1538 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (obfd
);
1540 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1541 for (i
= 1; i
< elf_numsections (obfd
); i
++)
1544 Elf_Internal_Shdr
* oheader
= oheaders
[i
];
1546 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1547 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1548 files. See below for more details. */
1550 || (oheader
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
1551 && oheader
->sh_type
< SHT_LOOS
))
1554 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1555 fields have already been initialised. */
1556 if (oheader
->sh_size
== 0
1557 || (oheader
->sh_info
!= 0 && oheader
->sh_link
!= 0))
1560 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1561 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1562 for (j
= 1; j
< elf_numsections (ibfd
); j
++)
1564 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* iheader
= iheaders
[j
];
1566 if (iheader
== NULL
)
1569 if (oheader
->bfd_section
!= NULL
1570 && iheader
->bfd_section
!= NULL
1571 && iheader
->bfd_section
->output_section
!= NULL
1572 && iheader
->bfd_section
->output_section
== oheader
->bfd_section
)
1574 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1575 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1576 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1577 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1578 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd
, obfd
, iheader
, oheader
, i
))
1579 j
= elf_numsections (ibfd
);
1584 if (j
< elf_numsections (ibfd
))
1587 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1588 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1589 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1590 for (j
= 1; j
< elf_numsections (ibfd
); j
++)
1592 const Elf_Internal_Shdr
* iheader
= iheaders
[j
];
1594 if (iheader
== NULL
)
1597 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1598 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1599 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1601 if ((oheader
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
1602 || iheader
->sh_type
== oheader
->sh_type
)
1603 && (iheader
->sh_flags
& ~ SHF_INFO_LINK
)
1604 == (oheader
->sh_flags
& ~ SHF_INFO_LINK
)
1605 && iheader
->sh_addralign
== oheader
->sh_addralign
1606 && iheader
->sh_entsize
== oheader
->sh_entsize
1607 && iheader
->sh_size
== oheader
->sh_size
1608 && iheader
->sh_addr
== oheader
->sh_addr
1609 && (iheader
->sh_info
!= oheader
->sh_info
1610 || iheader
->sh_link
!= oheader
->sh_link
))
1612 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd
, obfd
, iheader
, oheader
, i
))
1617 if (j
== elf_numsections (ibfd
) && oheader
->sh_type
>= SHT_LOOS
)
1619 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1620 with a NULL input section. */
1621 if (bed
->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
!= NULL
)
1622 bed
->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd
, obfd
, NULL
, oheader
);
1630 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type
)
1635 case PT_NULL
: pt
= "NULL"; break;
1636 case PT_LOAD
: pt
= "LOAD"; break;
1637 case PT_DYNAMIC
: pt
= "DYNAMIC"; break;
1638 case PT_INTERP
: pt
= "INTERP"; break;
1639 case PT_NOTE
: pt
= "NOTE"; break;
1640 case PT_SHLIB
: pt
= "SHLIB"; break;
1641 case PT_PHDR
: pt
= "PHDR"; break;
1642 case PT_TLS
: pt
= "TLS"; break;
1643 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
: pt
= "EH_FRAME"; break;
1644 case PT_GNU_STACK
: pt
= "STACK"; break;
1645 case PT_GNU_RELRO
: pt
= "RELRO"; break;
1646 default: pt
= NULL
; break;
1651 /* Print out the program headers. */
1654 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd
*abfd
, void *farg
)
1656 FILE *f
= (FILE *) farg
;
1657 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*p
;
1659 bfd_byte
*dynbuf
= NULL
;
1661 p
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
1666 fprintf (f
, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1667 c
= elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
;
1668 for (i
= 0; i
< c
; i
++, p
++)
1670 const char *pt
= get_segment_type (p
->p_type
);
1675 sprintf (buf
, "0x%lx", p
->p_type
);
1678 fprintf (f
, "%8s off 0x", pt
);
1679 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_offset
);
1680 fprintf (f
, " vaddr 0x");
1681 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_vaddr
);
1682 fprintf (f
, " paddr 0x");
1683 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_paddr
);
1684 fprintf (f
, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p
->p_align
));
1685 fprintf (f
, " filesz 0x");
1686 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_filesz
);
1687 fprintf (f
, " memsz 0x");
1688 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, p
->p_memsz
);
1689 fprintf (f
, " flags %c%c%c",
1690 (p
->p_flags
& PF_R
) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1691 (p
->p_flags
& PF_W
) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1692 (p
->p_flags
& PF_X
) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1693 if ((p
->p_flags
&~ (unsigned) (PF_R
| PF_W
| PF_X
)) != 0)
1694 fprintf (f
, " %lx", p
->p_flags
&~ (unsigned) (PF_R
| PF_W
| PF_X
));
1699 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynamic");
1702 unsigned int elfsec
;
1703 unsigned long shlink
;
1704 bfd_byte
*extdyn
, *extdynend
;
1706 void (*swap_dyn_in
) (bfd
*, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn
*);
1708 fprintf (f
, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1710 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd
, s
, &dynbuf
))
1713 elfsec
= _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd
, s
);
1714 if (elfsec
== SHN_BAD
)
1716 shlink
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elfsec
]->sh_link
;
1718 extdynsize
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->sizeof_dyn
;
1719 swap_dyn_in
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->swap_dyn_in
;
1722 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1723 if (s
->size
< extdynsize
)
1725 extdynend
= extdyn
+ s
->size
;
1726 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1728 for (; extdyn
<= (extdynend
- extdynsize
); extdyn
+= extdynsize
)
1730 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn
;
1731 const char *name
= "";
1733 bfd_boolean stringp
;
1734 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
1736 (*swap_dyn_in
) (abfd
, extdyn
, &dyn
);
1738 if (dyn
.d_tag
== DT_NULL
)
1745 if (bed
->elf_backend_get_target_dtag
)
1746 name
= (*bed
->elf_backend_get_target_dtag
) (dyn
.d_tag
);
1748 if (!strcmp (name
, ""))
1750 sprintf (ab
, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT
"x", dyn
.d_tag
);
1755 case DT_NEEDED
: name
= "NEEDED"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1756 case DT_PLTRELSZ
: name
= "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1757 case DT_PLTGOT
: name
= "PLTGOT"; break;
1758 case DT_HASH
: name
= "HASH"; break;
1759 case DT_STRTAB
: name
= "STRTAB"; break;
1760 case DT_SYMTAB
: name
= "SYMTAB"; break;
1761 case DT_RELA
: name
= "RELA"; break;
1762 case DT_RELASZ
: name
= "RELASZ"; break;
1763 case DT_RELAENT
: name
= "RELAENT"; break;
1764 case DT_STRSZ
: name
= "STRSZ"; break;
1765 case DT_SYMENT
: name
= "SYMENT"; break;
1766 case DT_INIT
: name
= "INIT"; break;
1767 case DT_FINI
: name
= "FINI"; break;
1768 case DT_SONAME
: name
= "SONAME"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1769 case DT_RPATH
: name
= "RPATH"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1770 case DT_SYMBOLIC
: name
= "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1771 case DT_REL
: name
= "REL"; break;
1772 case DT_RELSZ
: name
= "RELSZ"; break;
1773 case DT_RELENT
: name
= "RELENT"; break;
1774 case DT_PLTREL
: name
= "PLTREL"; break;
1775 case DT_DEBUG
: name
= "DEBUG"; break;
1776 case DT_TEXTREL
: name
= "TEXTREL"; break;
1777 case DT_JMPREL
: name
= "JMPREL"; break;
1778 case DT_BIND_NOW
: name
= "BIND_NOW"; break;
1779 case DT_INIT_ARRAY
: name
= "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1780 case DT_FINI_ARRAY
: name
= "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1781 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ
: name
= "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1782 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ
: name
= "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1783 case DT_RUNPATH
: name
= "RUNPATH"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1784 case DT_FLAGS
: name
= "FLAGS"; break;
1785 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY
: name
= "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1786 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ
: name
= "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1787 case DT_CHECKSUM
: name
= "CHECKSUM"; break;
1788 case DT_PLTPADSZ
: name
= "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1789 case DT_MOVEENT
: name
= "MOVEENT"; break;
1790 case DT_MOVESZ
: name
= "MOVESZ"; break;
1791 case DT_FEATURE
: name
= "FEATURE"; break;
1792 case DT_POSFLAG_1
: name
= "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1793 case DT_SYMINSZ
: name
= "SYMINSZ"; break;
1794 case DT_SYMINENT
: name
= "SYMINENT"; break;
1795 case DT_CONFIG
: name
= "CONFIG"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1796 case DT_DEPAUDIT
: name
= "DEPAUDIT"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1797 case DT_AUDIT
: name
= "AUDIT"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1798 case DT_PLTPAD
: name
= "PLTPAD"; break;
1799 case DT_MOVETAB
: name
= "MOVETAB"; break;
1800 case DT_SYMINFO
: name
= "SYMINFO"; break;
1801 case DT_RELACOUNT
: name
= "RELACOUNT"; break;
1802 case DT_RELCOUNT
: name
= "RELCOUNT"; break;
1803 case DT_FLAGS_1
: name
= "FLAGS_1"; break;
1804 case DT_VERSYM
: name
= "VERSYM"; break;
1805 case DT_VERDEF
: name
= "VERDEF"; break;
1806 case DT_VERDEFNUM
: name
= "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1807 case DT_VERNEED
: name
= "VERNEED"; break;
1808 case DT_VERNEEDNUM
: name
= "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1809 case DT_AUXILIARY
: name
= "AUXILIARY"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1810 case DT_USED
: name
= "USED"; break;
1811 case DT_FILTER
: name
= "FILTER"; stringp
= TRUE
; break;
1812 case DT_GNU_HASH
: name
= "GNU_HASH"; break;
1815 fprintf (f
, " %-20s ", name
);
1819 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, f
, dyn
.d_un
.d_val
);
1824 unsigned int tagv
= dyn
.d_un
.d_val
;
1826 string
= bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, shlink
, tagv
);
1829 fprintf (f
, "%s", string
);
1838 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd
) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
== NULL
)
1839 || (elf_dynverref (abfd
) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
== NULL
))
1841 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd
, FALSE
))
1845 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd
) != 0)
1847 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*t
;
1849 fprintf (f
, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1850 for (t
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
; t
!= NULL
; t
= t
->vd_nextdef
)
1852 fprintf (f
, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t
->vd_ndx
,
1853 t
->vd_flags
, t
->vd_hash
,
1854 t
->vd_nodename
? t
->vd_nodename
: "<corrupt>");
1855 if (t
->vd_auxptr
!= NULL
&& t
->vd_auxptr
->vda_nextptr
!= NULL
)
1857 Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*a
;
1860 for (a
= t
->vd_auxptr
->vda_nextptr
;
1864 a
->vda_nodename
? a
->vda_nodename
: "<corrupt>");
1870 if (elf_dynverref (abfd
) != 0)
1872 Elf_Internal_Verneed
*t
;
1874 fprintf (f
, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1875 for (t
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
; t
!= NULL
; t
= t
->vn_nextref
)
1877 Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*a
;
1879 fprintf (f
, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1880 t
->vn_filename
? t
->vn_filename
: "<corrupt>");
1881 for (a
= t
->vn_auxptr
; a
!= NULL
; a
= a
->vna_nextptr
)
1882 fprintf (f
, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a
->vna_hash
,
1883 a
->vna_flags
, a
->vna_other
,
1884 a
->vna_nodename
? a
->vna_nodename
: "<corrupt>");
1896 /* Get version string. */
1899 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
*symbol
,
1900 bfd_boolean
*hidden
)
1902 const char *version_string
= NULL
;
1903 if (elf_dynversym (abfd
) != 0
1904 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd
) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd
) != 0))
1906 unsigned int vernum
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) symbol
)->version
;
1908 *hidden
= (vernum
& VERSYM_HIDDEN
) != 0;
1909 vernum
&= VERSYM_VERSION
;
1912 version_string
= "";
1913 else if (vernum
== 1
1914 && (vernum
> elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
1915 || (elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
[0].vd_flags
1917 version_string
= "Base";
1918 else if (vernum
<= elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
)
1920 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
[vernum
- 1].vd_nodename
;
1923 Elf_Internal_Verneed
*t
;
1925 version_string
= _("<corrupt>");
1926 for (t
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
;
1930 Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*a
;
1932 for (a
= t
->vn_auxptr
; a
!= NULL
; a
= a
->vna_nextptr
)
1934 if (a
->vna_other
== vernum
)
1936 version_string
= a
->vna_nodename
;
1943 return version_string
;
1946 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1949 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd
*abfd
,
1952 bfd_print_symbol_type how
)
1954 FILE *file
= (FILE *) filep
;
1957 case bfd_print_symbol_name
:
1958 fprintf (file
, "%s", symbol
->name
);
1960 case bfd_print_symbol_more
:
1961 fprintf (file
, "elf ");
1962 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, file
, symbol
->value
);
1963 fprintf (file
, " %x", symbol
->flags
);
1965 case bfd_print_symbol_all
:
1967 const char *section_name
;
1968 const char *name
= NULL
;
1969 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
1970 unsigned char st_other
;
1972 const char *version_string
;
1975 section_name
= symbol
->section
? symbol
->section
->name
: "(*none*)";
1977 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
1978 if (bed
->elf_backend_print_symbol_all
)
1979 name
= (*bed
->elf_backend_print_symbol_all
) (abfd
, filep
, symbol
);
1983 name
= symbol
->name
;
1984 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd
, file
, symbol
);
1987 fprintf (file
, " %s\t", section_name
);
1988 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1989 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1990 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1991 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1992 if (symbol
->section
&& bfd_is_com_section (symbol
->section
))
1993 val
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) symbol
)->internal_elf_sym
.st_value
;
1995 val
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) symbol
)->internal_elf_sym
.st_size
;
1996 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd
, file
, val
);
1998 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1999 version_string
= _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd
,
2005 fprintf (file
, " %-11s", version_string
);
2010 fprintf (file
, " (%s)", version_string
);
2011 for (i
= 10 - strlen (version_string
); i
> 0; --i
)
2016 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
2017 st_other
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) symbol
)->internal_elf_sym
.st_other
;
2022 case STV_INTERNAL
: fprintf (file
, " .internal"); break;
2023 case STV_HIDDEN
: fprintf (file
, " .hidden"); break;
2024 case STV_PROTECTED
: fprintf (file
, " .protected"); break;
2026 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
2028 fprintf (file
, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other
);
2031 fprintf (file
, " %s", name
);
2037 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
2039 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
2042 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd
*abfd
, unsigned int shindex
)
2044 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
2045 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*ehdr
;
2046 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
2048 bfd_boolean ret
= TRUE
;
2049 static bfd_boolean
* sections_being_created
= NULL
;
2050 static bfd
* sections_being_created_abfd
= NULL
;
2051 static unsigned int nesting
= 0;
2053 if (shindex
>= elf_numsections (abfd
))
2058 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
2059 sections, with each the string indices pointing to the next in the
2060 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
2061 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2062 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2063 can expect to recurse at least once.
2065 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2066 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2068 if (sections_being_created_abfd
!= abfd
)
2069 sections_being_created
= NULL
;
2070 if (sections_being_created
== NULL
)
2072 sections_being_created
= (bfd_boolean
*)
2073 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd
, elf_numsections (abfd
), sizeof (bfd_boolean
));
2074 sections_being_created_abfd
= abfd
;
2076 if (sections_being_created
[shindex
])
2079 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd
);
2082 sections_being_created
[shindex
] = TRUE
;
2085 hdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
];
2086 ehdr
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
2087 name
= bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, ehdr
->e_shstrndx
,
2092 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
2093 switch (hdr
->sh_type
)
2096 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2099 case SHT_PROGBITS
: /* Normal section with contents. */
2100 case SHT_NOBITS
: /* .bss section. */
2101 case SHT_HASH
: /* .hash section. */
2102 case SHT_NOTE
: /* .note section. */
2103 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY
: /* .init_array section. */
2104 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY
: /* .fini_array section. */
2105 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY
: /* .preinit_array section. */
2106 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST
: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2107 case SHT_GNU_HASH
: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2108 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2111 case SHT_DYNAMIC
: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2112 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2115 if (hdr
->sh_link
> elf_numsections (abfd
))
2117 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2118 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2119 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd
))
2122 case bfd_arch_sparc
:
2123 if (hdr
->sh_link
== (SHN_LORESERVE
& 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2124 || hdr
->sh_link
== ((SHN_LORESERVE
+ 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2126 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2131 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
] == NULL
)
2133 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
!= SHT_STRTAB
)
2135 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*dynsymhdr
;
2137 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2138 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2139 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2140 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) != 0)
2142 dynsymhdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)];
2143 hdr
->sh_link
= dynsymhdr
->sh_link
;
2147 unsigned int i
, num_sec
;
2149 num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
2150 for (i
= 1; i
< num_sec
; i
++)
2152 dynsymhdr
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
2153 if (dynsymhdr
->sh_type
== SHT_DYNSYM
)
2155 hdr
->sh_link
= dynsymhdr
->sh_link
;
2163 case SHT_SYMTAB
: /* A symbol table. */
2164 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd
) == shindex
)
2167 if (hdr
->sh_entsize
!= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
)
2170 if (hdr
->sh_info
* hdr
->sh_entsize
> hdr
->sh_size
)
2172 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
2174 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2175 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2176 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2181 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2182 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2183 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd
) != 0)
2186 /* xgettext:c-format */
2187 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2188 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2192 elf_onesymtab (abfd
) = shindex
;
2193 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd
) = *hdr
;
2194 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = hdr
= & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd
);
2195 abfd
->flags
|= HAS_SYMS
;
2197 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2198 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2199 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2200 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2201 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2203 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0
2204 && (abfd
->flags
& DYNAMIC
) != 0
2205 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2209 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2210 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2211 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2213 elf_section_list
* entry
;
2214 unsigned int i
, num_sec
;
2216 for (entry
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
); entry
!= NULL
; entry
= entry
->next
)
2217 if (entry
->hdr
.sh_link
== shindex
)
2220 num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
2221 for (i
= shindex
+ 1; i
< num_sec
; i
++)
2223 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr2
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
2225 if (hdr2
->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2226 && hdr2
->sh_link
== shindex
)
2231 for (i
= 1; i
< shindex
; i
++)
2233 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr2
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
2235 if (hdr2
->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2236 && hdr2
->sh_link
== shindex
)
2241 ret
= bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, i
);
2242 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2246 case SHT_DYNSYM
: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2247 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == shindex
)
2250 if (hdr
->sh_entsize
!= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
)
2253 if (hdr
->sh_info
* hdr
->sh_entsize
> hdr
->sh_size
)
2255 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
2258 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2259 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2260 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2265 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2266 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2267 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) != 0)
2270 /* xgettext:c-format */
2271 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2272 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2276 elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) = shindex
;
2277 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynsymtab_hdr
= *hdr
;
2278 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynsymtab_hdr
;
2279 abfd
->flags
|= HAS_SYMS
;
2281 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2282 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2283 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2286 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2288 elf_section_list
* entry
;
2290 for (entry
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
); entry
!= NULL
; entry
= entry
->next
)
2291 if (entry
->ndx
== shindex
)
2294 entry
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, sizeof (*entry
));
2297 entry
->ndx
= shindex
;
2299 entry
->next
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
);
2300 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) = entry
;
2301 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = & entry
->hdr
;
2305 case SHT_STRTAB
: /* A string table. */
2306 if (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
)
2309 if (ehdr
->e_shstrndx
== shindex
)
2311 elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
= *hdr
;
2312 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = &elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
;
2316 if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elf_onesymtab (abfd
)]->sh_link
== shindex
)
2319 elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
= *hdr
;
2320 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = &elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
;
2324 if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)]->sh_link
== shindex
)
2327 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynstrtab_hdr
= *hdr
;
2328 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynstrtab_hdr
;
2329 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = hdr
;
2330 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2332 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2337 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2338 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2339 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2340 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd
) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == 0)
2342 unsigned int i
, num_sec
;
2344 num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
2345 for (i
= 1; i
< num_sec
; i
++)
2347 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr2
= elf_elfsections (abfd
)[i
];
2348 if (hdr2
->sh_link
== shindex
)
2350 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2353 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, i
))
2355 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd
) == i
)
2357 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == i
)
2358 goto dynsymtab_strtab
;
2362 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2367 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2369 asection
*target_sect
;
2370 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr2
, **p_hdr
;
2371 unsigned int num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
2372 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*esdt
;
2375 != (bfd_size_type
) (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_REL
2376 ? bed
->s
->sizeof_rel
: bed
->s
->sizeof_rela
))
2379 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2380 if (hdr
->sh_link
>= num_sec
)
2383 /* xgettext:c-format */
2384 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2385 abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
, name
, shindex
);
2386 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2391 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2392 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2393 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2394 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2395 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2396 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2397 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2399 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2400 if ((abfd
->flags
& (DYNAMIC
| EXEC_P
)) == 0
2401 && elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
!= SHT_SYMTAB
2402 && elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
!= SHT_DYNSYM
)
2408 for (scan
= 1; scan
< num_sec
; scan
++)
2410 if (elf_elfsections (abfd
)[scan
]->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB
2411 || elf_elfsections (abfd
)[scan
]->sh_type
== SHT_DYNSYM
)
2422 hdr
->sh_link
= found
;
2425 /* Get the symbol table. */
2426 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB
2427 || elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_link
]->sh_type
== SHT_DYNSYM
)
2428 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
))
2431 /* If this is an alloc section in an executable or shared
2432 library, or the reloc section does not use the main symbol
2433 table we don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't
2434 adequately represent such a section, so at least for now,
2435 we don't try. We just present it as a normal section. We
2436 also can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the
2437 null section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or
2438 its sh_link points to the null section. */
2439 if (((abfd
->flags
& (DYNAMIC
| EXEC_P
)) != 0
2440 && (hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
2441 || hdr
->sh_link
== SHN_UNDEF
2442 || hdr
->sh_link
!= elf_onesymtab (abfd
)
2443 || hdr
->sh_info
== SHN_UNDEF
2444 || hdr
->sh_info
>= num_sec
2445 || elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_info
]->sh_type
== SHT_REL
2446 || elf_elfsections (abfd
)[hdr
->sh_info
]->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
2448 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2453 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
->sh_info
))
2456 target_sect
= bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd
, hdr
->sh_info
);
2457 if (target_sect
== NULL
)
2460 esdt
= elf_section_data (target_sect
);
2461 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
2462 p_hdr
= &esdt
->rela
.hdr
;
2464 p_hdr
= &esdt
->rel
.hdr
;
2466 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7.
2467 Also see PR 24456, for a file which deliberately has two reloc
2472 /* xgettext:c-format */
2473 (_("%pB: warning: multiple relocation sections for section %pA \
2474 found - ignoring all but the first"),
2478 hdr2
= (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*) bfd_alloc (abfd
, sizeof (*hdr2
));
2483 elf_elfsections (abfd
)[shindex
] = hdr2
;
2484 target_sect
->reloc_count
+= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr
)
2485 * bed
->s
->int_rels_per_ext_rel
);
2486 target_sect
->flags
|= SEC_RELOC
;
2487 target_sect
->relocation
= NULL
;
2488 target_sect
->rel_filepos
= hdr
->sh_offset
;
2489 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2490 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2491 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
2493 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
2494 target_sect
->use_rela_p
= 1;
2496 abfd
->flags
|= HAS_RELOC
;
2500 case SHT_GNU_verdef
:
2501 elf_dynverdef (abfd
) = shindex
;
2502 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynverdef_hdr
= *hdr
;
2503 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2506 case SHT_GNU_versym
:
2507 if (hdr
->sh_entsize
!= sizeof (Elf_External_Versym
))
2510 elf_dynversym (abfd
) = shindex
;
2511 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynversym_hdr
= *hdr
;
2512 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2515 case SHT_GNU_verneed
:
2516 elf_dynverref (abfd
) = shindex
;
2517 elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynverref_hdr
= *hdr
;
2518 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2525 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr
, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE
))
2528 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2534 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2535 if (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2536 || hdr
->sh_type
== bed
->obj_attrs_section_type
)
2538 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2540 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd
, hdr
);
2544 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2545 if (bed
->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
))
2548 if (hdr
->sh_type
>= SHT_LOUSER
&& hdr
->sh_type
<= SHT_HIUSER
)
2550 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
2551 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2552 for applications? */
2554 /* xgettext:c-format */
2555 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2556 abfd
, hdr
->sh_type
, name
);
2559 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2560 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
,
2565 else if (hdr
->sh_type
>= SHT_LOPROC
2566 && hdr
->sh_type
<= SHT_HIPROC
)
2567 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2569 /* xgettext:c-format */
2570 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2571 abfd
, hdr
->sh_type
, name
);
2572 else if (hdr
->sh_type
>= SHT_LOOS
&& hdr
->sh_type
<= SHT_HIOS
)
2574 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2575 if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING
) != 0)
2576 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2577 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2578 be rejected with an error message. */
2580 /* xgettext:c-format */
2581 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2582 abfd
, hdr
->sh_type
, name
);
2585 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2586 ret
= _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd
, hdr
, name
, shindex
);
2591 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2593 /* xgettext:c-format */
2594 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2595 abfd
, hdr
->sh_type
, name
);
2603 if (sections_being_created
&& sections_being_created_abfd
== abfd
)
2604 sections_being_created
[shindex
] = FALSE
;
2605 if (-- nesting
== 0)
2607 sections_being_created
= NULL
;
2608 sections_being_created_abfd
= abfd
;
2613 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2616 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache
*cache
,
2618 unsigned long r_symndx
)
2620 unsigned int ent
= r_symndx
% LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE
;
2622 if (cache
->abfd
!= abfd
|| cache
->indx
[ent
] != r_symndx
)
2624 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
;
2625 unsigned char esym
[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym
)];
2626 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx
;
2628 symtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
;
2629 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd
, symtab_hdr
, 1, r_symndx
,
2630 &cache
->sym
[ent
], esym
, &eshndx
) == NULL
)
2633 if (cache
->abfd
!= abfd
)
2635 memset (cache
->indx
, -1, sizeof (cache
->indx
));
2638 cache
->indx
[ent
] = r_symndx
;
2641 return &cache
->sym
[ent
];
2644 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2648 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd
*abfd
, unsigned int sec_index
)
2650 if (sec_index
>= elf_numsections (abfd
))
2652 return elf_elfsections (abfd
)[sec_index
]->bfd_section
;
2655 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b
[] =
2657 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2658 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2661 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c
[] =
2663 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2664 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ctf"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2665 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2668 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d
[] =
2670 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2671 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2672 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2673 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2674 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2675 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2676 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2677 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2678 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2679 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2680 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2681 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2682 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2683 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2686 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f
[] =
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_EXECINSTR
},
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2690 { NULL
, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2693 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g
[] =
2695 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2696 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_EXCLUDE
},
2697 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2698 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym
, 0 },
2699 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef
, 0 },
2700 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed
, 0 },
2701 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2702 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2703 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2704 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2707 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h
[] =
2709 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2710 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2713 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i
[] =
2715 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_EXECINSTR
},
2716 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2717 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2718 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2721 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l
[] =
2723 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2724 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2727 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n
[] =
2729 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2730 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE
, 0 },
2731 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2734 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p
[] =
2736 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
},
2737 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_EXECINSTR
},
2738 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2741 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r
[] =
2743 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2744 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
},
2745 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA
, 0 },
2746 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL
, 0 },
2747 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2750 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s
[] =
2752 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB
, 0 },
2753 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB
, 0 },
2754 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB
, 0 },
2755 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2756 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2757 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB
, 0 },
2758 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2761 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t
[] =
2763 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_EXECINSTR
},
2764 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
+ SHF_TLS
},
2765 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS
, SHF_ALLOC
+ SHF_WRITE
+ SHF_TLS
},
2766 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2769 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z
[] =
2771 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2772 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2773 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2774 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS
, 0 },
2775 { NULL
, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2778 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section
* const special_sections
[] =
2780 special_sections_b
, /* 'b' */
2781 special_sections_c
, /* 'c' */
2782 special_sections_d
, /* 'd' */
2784 special_sections_f
, /* 'f' */
2785 special_sections_g
, /* 'g' */
2786 special_sections_h
, /* 'h' */
2787 special_sections_i
, /* 'i' */
2790 special_sections_l
, /* 'l' */
2792 special_sections_n
, /* 'n' */
2794 special_sections_p
, /* 'p' */
2796 special_sections_r
, /* 'r' */
2797 special_sections_s
, /* 's' */
2798 special_sections_t
, /* 't' */
2804 special_sections_z
/* 'z' */
2807 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*
2808 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name
,
2809 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*spec
,
2815 len
= strlen (name
);
2817 for (i
= 0; spec
[i
].prefix
!= NULL
; i
++)
2820 int prefix_len
= spec
[i
].prefix_length
;
2822 if (len
< prefix_len
)
2824 if (memcmp (name
, spec
[i
].prefix
, prefix_len
) != 0)
2827 suffix_len
= spec
[i
].suffix_length
;
2828 if (suffix_len
<= 0)
2830 if (name
[prefix_len
] != 0)
2832 if (suffix_len
== 0)
2834 if (name
[prefix_len
] != '.'
2835 && (suffix_len
== -2
2836 || (rela
&& spec
[i
].type
== SHT_REL
)))
2842 if (len
< prefix_len
+ suffix_len
)
2844 if (memcmp (name
+ len
- suffix_len
,
2845 spec
[i
].prefix
+ prefix_len
,
2855 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*
2856 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*sec
)
2859 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*spec
;
2860 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
2862 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2863 if (sec
->name
== NULL
)
2866 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
2867 spec
= bed
->special_sections
;
2870 spec
= _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec
->name
,
2871 bed
->special_sections
,
2877 if (sec
->name
[0] != '.')
2880 i
= sec
->name
[1] - 'b';
2881 if (i
< 0 || i
> 'z' - 'b')
2884 spec
= special_sections
[i
];
2889 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec
->name
, spec
, sec
->use_rela_p
);
2893 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*sec
)
2895 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*sdata
;
2896 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
2897 const struct bfd_elf_special_section
*ssect
;
2899 sdata
= (struct bfd_elf_section_data
*) sec
->used_by_bfd
;
2902 sdata
= (struct bfd_elf_section_data
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
,
2906 sec
->used_by_bfd
= sdata
;
2909 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2910 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
2911 sec
->use_rela_p
= bed
->default_use_rela_p
;
2913 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2914 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2915 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2916 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2917 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2918 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2919 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2920 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2921 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2922 if (abfd
->direction
!= read_direction
2923 || (sec
->flags
& SEC_LINKER_CREATED
) != 0)
2925 ssect
= (*bed
->get_sec_type_attr
) (abfd
, sec
);
2928 || (sec
->flags
& SEC_LINKER_CREATED
) != 0
2929 || ssect
->type
== SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2930 || ssect
->type
== SHT_FINI_ARRAY
))
2932 elf_section_type (sec
) = ssect
->type
;
2933 elf_section_flags (sec
) = ssect
->attr
;
2937 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd
, sec
);
2940 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2942 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2943 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2944 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2945 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2947 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2948 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2949 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2950 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2951 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2952 of combined data+bss.
2954 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2955 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2956 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2957 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2958 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2963 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd
*abfd
,
2964 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*hdr
,
2966 const char *type_name
)
2974 split
= ((hdr
->p_memsz
> 0)
2975 && (hdr
->p_filesz
> 0)
2976 && (hdr
->p_memsz
> hdr
->p_filesz
));
2978 if (hdr
->p_filesz
> 0)
2980 sprintf (namebuf
, "%s%d%s", type_name
, hdr_index
, split
? "a" : "");
2981 len
= strlen (namebuf
) + 1;
2982 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
2985 memcpy (name
, namebuf
, len
);
2986 newsect
= bfd_make_section (abfd
, name
);
2987 if (newsect
== NULL
)
2989 newsect
->vma
= hdr
->p_vaddr
;
2990 newsect
->lma
= hdr
->p_paddr
;
2991 newsect
->size
= hdr
->p_filesz
;
2992 newsect
->filepos
= hdr
->p_offset
;
2993 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
;
2994 newsect
->alignment_power
= bfd_log2 (hdr
->p_align
);
2995 if (hdr
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
2997 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_ALLOC
;
2998 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_LOAD
;
2999 if (hdr
->p_flags
& PF_X
)
3001 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
3003 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_CODE
;
3006 if (!(hdr
->p_flags
& PF_W
))
3008 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_READONLY
;
3012 if (hdr
->p_memsz
> hdr
->p_filesz
)
3016 sprintf (namebuf
, "%s%d%s", type_name
, hdr_index
, split
? "b" : "");
3017 len
= strlen (namebuf
) + 1;
3018 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
3021 memcpy (name
, namebuf
, len
);
3022 newsect
= bfd_make_section (abfd
, name
);
3023 if (newsect
== NULL
)
3025 newsect
->vma
= hdr
->p_vaddr
+ hdr
->p_filesz
;
3026 newsect
->lma
= hdr
->p_paddr
+ hdr
->p_filesz
;
3027 newsect
->size
= hdr
->p_memsz
- hdr
->p_filesz
;
3028 newsect
->filepos
= hdr
->p_offset
+ hdr
->p_filesz
;
3029 align
= newsect
->vma
& -newsect
->vma
;
3030 if (align
== 0 || align
> hdr
->p_align
)
3031 align
= hdr
->p_align
;
3032 newsect
->alignment_power
= bfd_log2 (align
);
3033 if (hdr
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
3035 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
3036 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
3037 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
3038 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
3039 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
3040 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
3041 if (bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
)
3043 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_ALLOC
;
3044 if (hdr
->p_flags
& PF_X
)
3045 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_CODE
;
3047 if (!(hdr
->p_flags
& PF_W
))
3048 newsect
->flags
|= SEC_READONLY
;
3055 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (bfd
*templ
, bfd_vma offset
)
3057 /* The return value is ignored. Build-ids are considered optional. */
3058 if (templ
->xvec
->flavour
== bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
3059 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ
)->elf_backend_core_find_build_id
)
3065 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Phdr
*hdr
, int hdr_index
)
3067 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
3069 switch (hdr
->p_type
)
3072 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "null");
3075 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "load"))
3077 if (bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
&& abfd
->build_id
== NULL
)
3078 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (abfd
, hdr
->p_offset
);
3082 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "dynamic");
3085 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "interp");
3088 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "note"))
3090 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd
, hdr
->p_offset
, hdr
->p_filesz
,
3096 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "shlib");
3099 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "phdr");
3101 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
:
3102 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
,
3106 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "stack");
3109 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "relro");
3112 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3113 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3114 return bed
->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd
, hdr
, hdr_index
, "proc");
3118 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3122 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection
*sec
)
3124 if (elf_section_data (sec
)->rel
.hdr
)
3126 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec
)->rela
.hdr
== NULL
);
3127 return elf_section_data (sec
)->rel
.hdr
;
3130 return elf_section_data (sec
)->rela
.hdr
;
3134 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd
*abfd
,
3135 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*rel_hdr
,
3136 const char *sec_name
,
3137 bfd_boolean use_rela_p
)
3139 char *name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
,
3140 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name
));
3144 sprintf (name
, "%s%s", use_rela_p
? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name
);
3146 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), name
,
3148 if (rel_hdr
->sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1)
3154 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3155 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3156 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3160 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd
*abfd
,
3161 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data
*reldata
,
3162 const char *sec_name
,
3163 bfd_boolean use_rela_p
,
3164 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p
)
3166 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*rel_hdr
;
3167 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3169 BFD_ASSERT (reldata
->hdr
== NULL
);
3170 rel_hdr
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (*rel_hdr
));
3171 reldata
->hdr
= rel_hdr
;
3173 if (delay_st_name_p
)
3174 rel_hdr
->sh_name
= (unsigned int) -1;
3175 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd
, rel_hdr
, sec_name
,
3178 rel_hdr
->sh_type
= use_rela_p
? SHT_RELA
: SHT_REL
;
3179 rel_hdr
->sh_entsize
= (use_rela_p
3180 ? bed
->s
->sizeof_rela
3181 : bed
->s
->sizeof_rel
);
3182 rel_hdr
->sh_addralign
= (bfd_vma
) 1 << bed
->s
->log_file_align
;
3183 rel_hdr
->sh_flags
= 0;
3184 rel_hdr
->sh_addr
= 0;
3185 rel_hdr
->sh_size
= 0;
3186 rel_hdr
->sh_offset
= 0;
3191 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3194 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags
)
3196 if ((flags
& (SEC_ALLOC
| SEC_IS_COMMON
)) != 0
3197 && (flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
)) == 0)
3199 return SHT_PROGBITS
;
3202 struct fake_section_arg
3204 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
;
3208 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3211 elf_fake_sections (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*asect
, void *fsarg
)
3213 struct fake_section_arg
*arg
= (struct fake_section_arg
*)fsarg
;
3214 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3215 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*esd
= elf_section_data (asect
);
3216 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
3217 unsigned int sh_type
;
3218 const char *name
= asect
->name
;
3219 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p
= FALSE
;
3223 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3228 this_hdr
= &esd
->this_hdr
;
3232 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3233 if ((arg
->link_info
->compress_debug
& COMPRESS_DEBUG
)
3234 && (asect
->flags
& SEC_DEBUGGING
)
3238 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3240 asect
->flags
|= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
;
3242 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3243 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3244 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3245 delay_st_name_p
= TRUE
;
3248 else if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_ELF_RENAME
))
3250 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3251 if ((abfd
->flags
& (BFD_DECOMPRESS
| BFD_COMPRESS_GABI
)))
3253 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3254 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3258 char *new_name
= convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd
, name
);
3259 if (new_name
== NULL
)
3267 else if (asect
->compress_status
== COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
)
3269 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3270 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3271 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3272 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3273 char *new_name
= convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd
, name
);
3274 if (new_name
== NULL
)
3279 BFD_ASSERT (name
[1] != 'z');
3284 if (delay_st_name_p
)
3285 this_hdr
->sh_name
= (unsigned int) -1;
3289 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd
),
3291 if (this_hdr
->sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1)
3298 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3300 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0
3301 || asect
->user_set_vma
)
3302 this_hdr
->sh_addr
= asect
->vma
;
3304 this_hdr
->sh_addr
= 0;
3306 this_hdr
->sh_offset
= 0;
3307 this_hdr
->sh_size
= asect
->size
;
3308 this_hdr
->sh_link
= 0;
3309 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3310 if (asect
->alignment_power
>= (sizeof (bfd_vma
) * 8) - 1)
3313 /* xgettext:c-format */
3314 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3315 abfd
, asect
->alignment_power
, asect
);
3319 this_hdr
->sh_addralign
= (bfd_vma
) 1 << asect
->alignment_power
;
3320 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3321 copy_private_section_data. */
3323 this_hdr
->bfd_section
= asect
;
3324 this_hdr
->contents
= NULL
;
3326 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3328 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_GROUP
) != 0)
3329 sh_type
= SHT_GROUP
;
3331 sh_type
= bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect
->flags
);
3333 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NULL
)
3334 this_hdr
->sh_type
= sh_type
;
3335 else if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
3336 && sh_type
== SHT_PROGBITS
3337 && (asect
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
3339 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3340 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3341 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3342 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3344 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect
);
3345 this_hdr
->sh_type
= sh_type
;
3348 switch (this_hdr
->sh_type
)
3359 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY
:
3360 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY
:
3361 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY
:
3362 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->arch_size
/ 8;
3366 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_hash_entry
;
3370 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
;
3374 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_dyn
;
3378 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->may_use_rela_p
)
3379 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_rela
;
3383 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->may_use_rel_p
)
3384 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_rel
;
3387 case SHT_GNU_versym
:
3388 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= sizeof (Elf_External_Versym
);
3391 case SHT_GNU_verdef
:
3392 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= 0;
3393 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3394 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3396 if (this_hdr
->sh_info
== 0)
3397 this_hdr
->sh_info
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
;
3399 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
== 0
3400 || this_hdr
->sh_info
== elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
);
3403 case SHT_GNU_verneed
:
3404 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= 0;
3405 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3406 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3408 if (this_hdr
->sh_info
== 0)
3409 this_hdr
->sh_info
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
;
3411 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
== 0
3412 || this_hdr
->sh_info
== elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
);
3416 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= GRP_ENTRY_SIZE
;
3420 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->arch_size
== 64 ? 0 : 4;
3424 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
3425 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_ALLOC
;
3426 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
3427 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_WRITE
;
3428 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0)
3429 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_EXECINSTR
;
3430 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_MERGE
) != 0)
3432 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_MERGE
;
3433 this_hdr
->sh_entsize
= asect
->entsize
;
3435 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_STRINGS
) != 0)
3436 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_STRINGS
;
3437 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_GROUP
) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect
) != NULL
)
3438 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_GROUP
;
3439 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) != 0)
3441 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_TLS
;
3442 if (asect
->size
== 0
3443 && (asect
->flags
& SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
) == 0)
3445 struct bfd_link_order
*o
= asect
->map_tail
.link_order
;
3447 this_hdr
->sh_size
= 0;
3450 this_hdr
->sh_size
= o
->offset
+ o
->size
;
3451 if (this_hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
3452 this_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_NOBITS
;
3456 if ((asect
->flags
& (SEC_GROUP
| SEC_EXCLUDE
)) == SEC_EXCLUDE
)
3457 this_hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_EXCLUDE
;
3459 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3460 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3461 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3462 create the other. */
3463 if ((asect
->flags
& SEC_RELOC
) != 0)
3465 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3468 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3469 && esd
->rel
.count
+ esd
->rela
.count
> 0
3470 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg
->link_info
)
3471 || arg
->link_info
->emitrelocations
))
3473 if (esd
->rel
.count
&& esd
->rel
.hdr
== NULL
3474 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd
, &esd
->rel
, name
,
3475 FALSE
, delay_st_name_p
))
3480 if (esd
->rela
.count
&& esd
->rela
.hdr
== NULL
3481 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd
, &esd
->rela
, name
,
3482 TRUE
, delay_st_name_p
))
3488 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd
,
3490 ? &esd
->rela
: &esd
->rel
),
3500 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3501 sh_type
= this_hdr
->sh_type
;
3502 if (bed
->elf_backend_fake_sections
3503 && !(*bed
->elf_backend_fake_sections
) (abfd
, this_hdr
, asect
))
3509 if (sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
&& asect
->size
!= 0)
3511 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3512 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3513 this_hdr
->sh_type
= sh_type
;
3517 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3518 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3519 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3520 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3523 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*sec
, void *failedptrarg
)
3525 bfd_boolean
*failedptr
= (bfd_boolean
*) failedptrarg
;
3526 asection
*elt
, *first
;
3530 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3532 if ((sec
->flags
& (SEC_GROUP
| SEC_LINKER_CREATED
)) != SEC_GROUP
3537 if (elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
== 0)
3539 unsigned long symindx
= 0;
3541 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3543 if (elf_group_id (sec
) != NULL
)
3544 symindx
= elf_group_id (sec
)->udata
.i
;
3548 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3549 elf_section_syms. */
3550 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd
) != NULL
);
3551 symindx
= elf_section_syms (abfd
)[sec
->index
]->udata
.i
;
3553 elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
= symindx
;
3555 else if (elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
== (unsigned int) -2)
3557 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3558 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3559 set until all local symbols are output. */
3561 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*sec_data
;
3562 unsigned long symndx
;
3563 unsigned long extsymoff
;
3564 struct elf_link_hash_entry
*h
;
3566 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3567 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3568 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3569 igroup
= elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec
));
3570 sec_data
= elf_section_data (igroup
);
3571 symndx
= sec_data
->this_hdr
.sh_info
;
3573 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup
->owner
))
3575 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
;
3577 symtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (igroup
->owner
)->symtab_hdr
;
3578 extsymoff
= symtab_hdr
->sh_info
;
3580 h
= elf_sym_hashes (igroup
->owner
)[symndx
- extsymoff
];
3581 while (h
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_indirect
3582 || h
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_warning
)
3583 h
= (struct elf_link_hash_entry
*) h
->root
.u
.i
.link
;
3585 elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
= h
->indx
;
3588 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3590 if (sec
->contents
== NULL
)
3593 sec
->contents
= (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, sec
->size
);
3595 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3596 elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
.contents
= sec
->contents
;
3597 if (sec
->contents
== NULL
)
3604 loc
= sec
->contents
+ sec
->size
;
3606 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3607 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3608 start of the input section group. */
3609 first
= elt
= elf_next_in_group (sec
);
3611 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3612 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3613 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3614 directives, not that it matters. */
3621 s
= s
->output_section
;
3623 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s
))
3625 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*elf_sec
= elf_section_data (s
);
3626 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*input_elf_sec
= elf_section_data (elt
);
3628 if (elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
!= NULL
3630 || (input_elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
!= NULL
3631 && input_elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
) != 0))
3633 elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_GROUP
;
3635 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, elf_sec
->rel
.idx
, loc
);
3637 if (elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
!= NULL
3639 || (input_elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
!= NULL
3640 && input_elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
) != 0))
3642 elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_GROUP
;
3644 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, elf_sec
->rela
.idx
, loc
);
3647 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, elf_sec
->this_idx
, loc
);
3649 elt
= elf_next_in_group (elt
);
3655 BFD_ASSERT (loc
== sec
->contents
);
3657 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, sec
->flags
& SEC_LINK_ONCE
? GRP_COMDAT
: 0, loc
);
3660 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3661 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3662 relocations apply. */
3665 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd
*abfd
, const char *name
)
3667 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3668 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3669 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->want_got_plt
3670 && strcmp (name
, ".plt") == 0)
3675 sec
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, name
);
3681 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, name
);
3684 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3687 elf_get_reloc_section (asection
*reloc_sec
)
3692 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
3694 type
= elf_section_data (reloc_sec
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
;
3695 if (type
!= SHT_REL
&& type
!= SHT_RELA
)
3698 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3699 name
= reloc_sec
->name
;
3700 if (strncmp (name
, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3703 if (type
== SHT_RELA
&& *name
++ != 'a')
3706 abfd
= reloc_sec
->owner
;
3707 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3708 return bed
->get_reloc_section (abfd
, name
);
3711 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3712 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3713 in here too, while we're at it. */
3716 assign_section_numbers (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
3718 struct elf_obj_tdata
*t
= elf_tdata (abfd
);
3720 unsigned int section_number
;
3721 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**i_shdrp
;
3722 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*d
;
3723 bfd_boolean need_symtab
;
3727 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd
));
3729 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3730 if (link_info
== NULL
|| !link_info
->resolve_section_groups
)
3732 size_t reloc_count
= 0;
3734 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3735 for (sec
= abfd
->sections
; sec
!= NULL
; sec
= sec
->next
)
3737 d
= elf_section_data (sec
);
3739 if (d
->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_GROUP
)
3741 if (sec
->flags
& SEC_LINKER_CREATED
)
3743 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3744 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd
, sec
);
3745 abfd
->section_count
--;
3748 d
->this_idx
= section_number
++;
3751 /* Count relocations. */
3752 reloc_count
+= sec
->reloc_count
;
3755 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3756 if (reloc_count
== 0)
3757 abfd
->flags
&= ~HAS_RELOC
;
3760 for (sec
= abfd
->sections
; sec
; sec
= sec
->next
)
3762 d
= elf_section_data (sec
);
3764 if (d
->this_hdr
.sh_type
!= SHT_GROUP
)
3765 d
->this_idx
= section_number
++;
3766 if (d
->this_hdr
.sh_name
!= (unsigned int) -1)
3767 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), d
->this_hdr
.sh_name
);
3770 d
->rel
.idx
= section_number
++;
3771 if (d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_name
!= (unsigned int) -1)
3772 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_name
);
3779 d
->rela
.idx
= section_number
++;
3780 if (d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_name
!= (unsigned int) -1)
3781 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_name
);
3787 need_symtab
= (bfd_get_symcount (abfd
) > 0
3788 || (link_info
== NULL
3789 && ((abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
| HAS_RELOC
))
3793 elf_onesymtab (abfd
) = section_number
++;
3794 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), t
->symtab_hdr
.sh_name
);
3795 if (section_number
> ((SHN_LORESERVE
- 2) & 0xFFFF))
3797 elf_section_list
*entry
;
3799 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) == NULL
);
3801 entry
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (*entry
));
3802 entry
->ndx
= section_number
++;
3803 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) = entry
;
3805 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd
),
3806 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE
);
3807 if (entry
->hdr
.sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1)
3810 elf_strtab_sec (abfd
) = section_number
++;
3811 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), t
->strtab_hdr
.sh_name
);
3814 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
) = section_number
++;
3815 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd
), t
->shstrtab_hdr
.sh_name
);
3816 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_shstrndx
= elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
);
3818 if (section_number
>= SHN_LORESERVE
)
3820 /* xgettext:c-format */
3821 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3822 abfd
, section_number
);
3826 elf_numsections (abfd
) = section_number
;
3827 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_shnum
= section_number
;
3829 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3831 i_shdrp
= (Elf_Internal_Shdr
**) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd
, section_number
,
3832 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*));
3833 if (i_shdrp
== NULL
)
3836 i_shdrp
[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
,
3837 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr
));
3838 if (i_shdrp
[0] == NULL
)
3840 bfd_release (abfd
, i_shdrp
);
3844 elf_elfsections (abfd
) = i_shdrp
;
3846 i_shdrp
[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
)] = &t
->shstrtab_hdr
;
3849 i_shdrp
[elf_onesymtab (abfd
)] = &t
->symtab_hdr
;
3850 if (elf_numsections (abfd
) > (SHN_LORESERVE
& 0xFFFF))
3852 elf_section_list
* entry
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
);
3853 BFD_ASSERT (entry
!= NULL
);
3854 i_shdrp
[entry
->ndx
] = & entry
->hdr
;
3855 entry
->hdr
.sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
3857 i_shdrp
[elf_strtab_sec (abfd
)] = &t
->strtab_hdr
;
3858 t
->symtab_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_strtab_sec (abfd
);
3861 for (sec
= abfd
->sections
; sec
; sec
= sec
->next
)
3865 d
= elf_section_data (sec
);
3867 i_shdrp
[d
->this_idx
] = &d
->this_hdr
;
3868 if (d
->rel
.idx
!= 0)
3869 i_shdrp
[d
->rel
.idx
] = d
->rel
.hdr
;
3870 if (d
->rela
.idx
!= 0)
3871 i_shdrp
[d
->rela
.idx
] = d
->rela
.hdr
;
3873 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3875 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3876 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3877 the relocation entries apply. */
3878 if (d
->rel
.idx
!= 0)
3880 d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
3881 d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_info
= d
->this_idx
;
3882 d
->rel
.hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_INFO_LINK
;
3884 if (d
->rela
.idx
!= 0)
3886 d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
3887 d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_info
= d
->this_idx
;
3888 d
->rela
.hdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_INFO_LINK
;
3891 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3892 if ((d
->this_hdr
.sh_flags
& SHF_LINK_ORDER
) != 0)
3894 s
= elf_linked_to_section (sec
);
3897 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3898 if (link_info
!= NULL
)
3900 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3901 if (discarded_section (s
))
3905 /* xgettext:c-format */
3906 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3907 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3908 abfd
, d
->this_hdr
.bfd_section
,
3910 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3911 size as the discarded one. */
3912 kept
= _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s
, link_info
);
3915 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
3921 s
= s
->output_section
;
3922 BFD_ASSERT (s
!= NULL
);
3926 /* Handle objcopy. */
3927 if (s
->output_section
== NULL
)
3930 /* xgettext:c-format */
3931 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3932 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3933 abfd
, d
->this_hdr
.bfd_section
, s
, s
->owner
);
3934 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
3937 s
= s
->output_section
;
3939 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
3944 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3945 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3946 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3948 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
3949 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
3950 if (bed
->link_order_error_handler
)
3951 bed
->link_order_error_handler
3952 /* xgettext:c-format */
3953 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
3958 switch (d
->this_hdr
.sh_type
)
3962 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3963 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3964 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3965 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3966 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3967 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3968 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynsym");
3970 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
3972 s
= elf_get_reloc_section (sec
);
3975 d
->this_hdr
.sh_info
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
3976 d
->this_hdr
.sh_flags
|= SHF_INFO_LINK
;
3981 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3982 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3983 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3984 field to point to this section. */
3985 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec
->name
, ".stab")
3986 && strcmp (sec
->name
+ strlen (sec
->name
) - 3, "str") == 0)
3991 len
= strlen (sec
->name
);
3992 alc
= (char *) bfd_malloc (len
- 2);
3995 memcpy (alc
, sec
->name
, len
- 3);
3996 alc
[len
- 3] = '\0';
3997 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, alc
);
4001 elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_link
= d
->this_idx
;
4003 /* This is a .stab section. */
4004 if (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_entsize
== 0)
4005 elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_entsize
4006 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd
) / 8;
4013 case SHT_GNU_verneed
:
4014 case SHT_GNU_verdef
:
4015 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
4016 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
4018 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynstr");
4020 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
4023 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST
:
4024 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
4025 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
4026 the version strings. */
4027 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, (sec
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
)
4028 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
4030 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
4035 case SHT_GNU_versym
:
4036 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
4037 this hash table or version table is for. */
4038 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynsym");
4040 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_section_data (s
)->this_idx
;
4044 d
->this_hdr
.sh_link
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
4048 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
4049 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
4050 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
4056 sym_is_global (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
*sym
)
4058 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
4059 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4060 if (bed
->elf_backend_sym_is_global
)
4061 return (*bed
->elf_backend_sym_is_global
) (abfd
, sym
);
4063 return ((sym
->flags
& (BSF_GLOBAL
| BSF_WEAK
| BSF_GNU_UNIQUE
)) != 0
4064 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym
))
4065 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym
)));
4068 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
4069 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
4070 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
4071 the beginning of that array.
4073 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4076 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*info
,
4077 asymbol
**syms
, long symcount
)
4079 long src_count
, dst_count
= 0;
4081 for (src_count
= 0; src_count
< symcount
; src_count
++)
4083 asymbol
*sym
= syms
[src_count
];
4084 char *name
= (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym
);
4085 struct bfd_link_hash_entry
*h
;
4087 if (!sym_is_global (abfd
, sym
))
4090 h
= bfd_link_hash_lookup (info
->hash
, name
, FALSE
, FALSE
, FALSE
);
4093 if (h
->type
!= bfd_link_hash_defined
&& h
->type
!= bfd_link_hash_defweak
)
4095 if (h
->linker_def
|| h
->ldscript_def
)
4098 syms
[dst_count
++] = sym
;
4101 syms
[dst_count
] = NULL
;
4106 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4107 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4110 ignore_section_sym (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
*sym
)
4112 elf_symbol_type
*type_ptr
;
4117 if ((sym
->flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
) == 0)
4120 if (sym
->section
== NULL
)
4123 type_ptr
= elf_symbol_from (abfd
, sym
);
4124 return ((type_ptr
!= NULL
4125 && type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
!= 0
4126 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym
->section
))
4127 || !(sym
->section
->owner
== abfd
4128 || (sym
->section
->output_section
!= NULL
4129 && sym
->section
->output_section
->owner
== abfd
4130 && sym
->section
->output_offset
== 0)
4131 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym
->section
)));
4134 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4135 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4138 elf_map_symbols (bfd
*abfd
, unsigned int *pnum_locals
)
4140 unsigned int symcount
= bfd_get_symcount (abfd
);
4141 asymbol
**syms
= bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd
);
4142 asymbol
**sect_syms
;
4143 unsigned int num_locals
= 0;
4144 unsigned int num_globals
= 0;
4145 unsigned int num_locals2
= 0;
4146 unsigned int num_globals2
= 0;
4147 unsigned int max_index
= 0;
4153 fprintf (stderr
, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4157 for (asect
= abfd
->sections
; asect
; asect
= asect
->next
)
4159 if (max_index
< asect
->index
)
4160 max_index
= asect
->index
;
4164 sect_syms
= (asymbol
**) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd
, max_index
, sizeof (asymbol
*));
4165 if (sect_syms
== NULL
)
4167 elf_section_syms (abfd
) = sect_syms
;
4168 elf_num_section_syms (abfd
) = max_index
;
4170 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4171 decided to output. */
4172 for (idx
= 0; idx
< symcount
; idx
++)
4174 asymbol
*sym
= syms
[idx
];
4176 if ((sym
->flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
) != 0
4178 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd
, sym
)
4179 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym
->section
))
4181 asection
*sec
= sym
->section
;
4183 if (sec
->owner
!= abfd
)
4184 sec
= sec
->output_section
;
4186 sect_syms
[sec
->index
] = syms
[idx
];
4190 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4191 for (idx
= 0; idx
< symcount
; idx
++)
4193 if (sym_is_global (abfd
, syms
[idx
]))
4195 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd
, syms
[idx
]))
4199 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4200 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4201 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4202 at least in that case. */
4203 for (asect
= abfd
->sections
; asect
; asect
= asect
->next
)
4205 if (sect_syms
[asect
->index
] == NULL
)
4207 if (!sym_is_global (abfd
, asect
->symbol
))
4214 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4215 new_syms
= (asymbol
**) bfd_alloc2 (abfd
, num_locals
+ num_globals
,
4216 sizeof (asymbol
*));
4218 if (new_syms
== NULL
)
4221 for (idx
= 0; idx
< symcount
; idx
++)
4223 asymbol
*sym
= syms
[idx
];
4226 if (sym_is_global (abfd
, sym
))
4227 i
= num_locals
+ num_globals2
++;
4228 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd
, sym
))
4233 sym
->udata
.i
= i
+ 1;
4235 for (asect
= abfd
->sections
; asect
; asect
= asect
->next
)
4237 if (sect_syms
[asect
->index
] == NULL
)
4239 asymbol
*sym
= asect
->symbol
;
4242 sect_syms
[asect
->index
] = sym
;
4243 if (!sym_is_global (abfd
, sym
))
4246 i
= num_locals
+ num_globals2
++;
4248 sym
->udata
.i
= i
+ 1;
4252 bfd_set_symtab (abfd
, new_syms
, num_locals
+ num_globals
);
4254 *pnum_locals
= num_locals
;
4258 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4259 ELF data structure. */
4261 static inline file_ptr
4262 align_file_position (file_ptr off
, int align
)
4264 return (off
+ align
- 1) & ~(align
- 1);
4267 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4268 required section alignment. */
4271 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr
*i_shdrp
,
4275 if (align
&& i_shdrp
->sh_addralign
> 1)
4276 offset
= BFD_ALIGN (offset
, i_shdrp
->sh_addralign
);
4277 i_shdrp
->sh_offset
= offset
;
4278 if (i_shdrp
->bfd_section
!= NULL
)
4279 i_shdrp
->bfd_section
->filepos
= offset
;
4280 if (i_shdrp
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
4281 offset
+= i_shdrp
->sh_size
;
4285 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4286 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4287 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4290 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd
*abfd
,
4291 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
4293 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4294 struct fake_section_arg fsargs
;
4296 struct elf_strtab_hash
*strtab
= NULL
;
4297 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shstrtab_hdr
;
4298 bfd_boolean need_symtab
;
4300 if (abfd
->output_has_begun
)
4303 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4304 if (bed
->elf_backend_begin_write_processing
)
4305 (*bed
->elf_backend_begin_write_processing
) (abfd
, link_info
);
4307 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_init_file_header
) (abfd
, link_info
))
4310 fsargs
.failed
= FALSE
;
4311 fsargs
.link_info
= link_info
;
4312 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd
, elf_fake_sections
, &fsargs
);
4316 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd
, link_info
))
4319 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4320 need_symtab
= (link_info
== NULL
4321 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd
) > 0
4322 || ((abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
| HAS_RELOC
))
4326 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4327 int relocatable_p
= ! (abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
));
4329 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd
, &strtab
, relocatable_p
))
4334 if (link_info
== NULL
)
4336 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd
, bfd_elf_set_group_contents
, &failed
);
4341 shstrtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
;
4342 /* sh_name was set in init_file_header. */
4343 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_STRTAB
;
4344 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_flags
= bed
->elf_strtab_flags
;
4345 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_addr
= 0;
4346 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4347 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_entsize
= 0;
4348 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_link
= 0;
4349 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_info
= 0;
4350 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4351 shstrtab_hdr
->sh_addralign
= 1;
4353 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd
, link_info
))
4359 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
4361 off
= elf_next_file_pos (abfd
);
4363 hdr
= & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd
);
4364 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
4366 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) != NULL
)
4368 hdr
= & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->hdr
;
4369 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
4370 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
4371 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4374 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
;
4375 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
4377 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
4379 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4381 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, hdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
4382 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd
, strtab
))
4384 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab
);
4387 abfd
->output_has_begun
= TRUE
;
4392 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4393 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4395 static bfd_size_type
4396 get_program_header_size (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*info
)
4400 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
4402 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4403 and one for data. */
4406 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".interp");
4407 if (s
!= NULL
&& (s
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0 && s
->size
!= 0)
4409 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4410 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4411 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4416 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynamic") != NULL
)
4418 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4422 if (info
!= NULL
&& info
->relro
)
4424 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4428 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd
))
4430 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4434 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd
))
4436 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4440 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
,
4441 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME
);
4442 if (s
!= NULL
&& s
->size
!= 0)
4444 /* We need a PT_GNU_PROPERTY segment. */
4448 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4450 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0
4451 && elf_section_type (s
) == SHT_NOTE
)
4453 unsigned int alignment_power
;
4454 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4456 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment for all adjacent
4457 loadable SHT_NOTE sections. gABI requires that within a
4458 PT_NOTE segment (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4459 each note should have the same alignment. So we check
4460 whether the sections are correctly aligned. */
4461 alignment_power
= s
->alignment_power
;
4462 while (s
->next
!= NULL
4463 && s
->next
->alignment_power
== alignment_power
4464 && (s
->next
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0
4465 && elf_section_type (s
->next
) == SHT_NOTE
)
4470 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4472 if (s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)
4474 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4480 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4482 if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0
4483 && (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
) != 0)
4485 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4486 unsigned int page_align_power
= bfd_log2 (bed
->commonpagesize
);
4487 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4488 if (elf_section_flags (s
) & SHF_GNU_MBIND
)
4490 if (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
> PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM
)
4493 /* xgettext:c-format */
4494 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIND section `%pA' has invalid "
4495 "sh_info field: %d"),
4496 abfd
, s
, elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
);
4499 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4500 if (s
->alignment_power
< page_align_power
)
4501 s
->alignment_power
= page_align_power
;
4506 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4507 if (bed
->elf_backend_additional_program_headers
)
4511 a
= (*bed
->elf_backend_additional_program_headers
) (abfd
, info
);
4517 return segs
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
4520 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4523 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd
* abfd
, asection
* section
)
4525 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
4526 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*p
;
4528 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
), p
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
4534 for (i
= m
->count
- 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
4535 if (m
->sections
[i
] == section
)
4542 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4544 static struct elf_segment_map
*
4545 make_mapping (bfd
*abfd
,
4546 asection
**sections
,
4551 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
4556 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
4557 amt
+= (to
- from
) * sizeof (asection
*);
4558 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
4562 m
->p_type
= PT_LOAD
;
4563 for (i
= from
, hdrpp
= sections
+ from
; i
< to
; i
++, hdrpp
++)
4564 m
->sections
[i
- from
] = *hdrpp
;
4565 m
->count
= to
- from
;
4567 if (from
== 0 && phdr
)
4569 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4570 m
->includes_filehdr
= 1;
4571 m
->includes_phdrs
= 1;
4577 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4580 struct elf_segment_map
*
4581 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd
*abfd
, asection
*dynsec
)
4583 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
4585 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
,
4586 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
));
4590 m
->p_type
= PT_DYNAMIC
;
4592 m
->sections
[0] = dynsec
;
4597 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4600 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd
*abfd
,
4601 struct bfd_link_info
*info
,
4602 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load
)
4604 struct elf_segment_map
**m
;
4605 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
4607 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4608 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4609 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4610 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4612 m
= &elf_seg_map (abfd
);
4615 unsigned int i
, new_count
;
4617 for (new_count
= 0, i
= 0; i
< (*m
)->count
; i
++)
4619 if (((*m
)->sections
[i
]->flags
& SEC_EXCLUDE
) == 0
4620 && (((*m
)->sections
[i
]->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0
4621 || (*m
)->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
))
4623 (*m
)->sections
[new_count
] = (*m
)->sections
[i
];
4627 (*m
)->count
= new_count
;
4629 if (remove_empty_load
4630 && (*m
)->p_type
== PT_LOAD
4632 && !(*m
)->includes_phdrs
)
4638 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4639 if (bed
->elf_backend_modify_segment_map
!= NULL
)
4641 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_modify_segment_map
) (abfd
, info
))
4648 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4649 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4651 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4654 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*info
)
4657 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
4658 asection
**sections
= NULL
;
4659 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
4660 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs
;
4662 no_user_phdrs
= elf_seg_map (abfd
) == NULL
;
4665 info
->user_phdrs
= !no_user_phdrs
;
4667 if (no_user_phdrs
&& bfd_count_sections (abfd
) != 0)
4671 struct elf_segment_map
*mfirst
;
4672 struct elf_segment_map
**pm
;
4675 unsigned int hdr_index
;
4676 bfd_vma maxpagesize
;
4678 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment
;
4679 bfd_boolean writable
;
4680 bfd_boolean executable
;
4682 asection
*first_tls
= NULL
;
4683 asection
*first_mbind
= NULL
;
4684 asection
*dynsec
, *eh_frame_hdr
;
4686 bfd_vma addr_mask
, wrap_to
= 0;
4687 bfd_size_type phdr_size
;
4689 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4691 sections
= (asection
**) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd
),
4692 sizeof (asection
*));
4693 if (sections
== NULL
)
4696 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4697 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4699 addr_mask
= ((bfd_vma
) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd
) - 1)) - 1;
4700 addr_mask
= (addr_mask
<< 1) + 1;
4703 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
4705 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
4707 /* target_index is unused until bfd_elf_final_link
4708 starts output of section symbols. Use it to make
4710 s
->target_index
= i
;
4713 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4714 if (((s
->lma
+ s
->size
) & addr_mask
) < (s
->lma
& addr_mask
))
4715 wrap_to
= (s
->lma
+ s
->size
) & addr_mask
;
4718 BFD_ASSERT (i
<= bfd_count_sections (abfd
));
4721 qsort (sections
, (size_t) count
, sizeof (asection
*), elf_sort_sections
);
4723 phdr_size
= elf_program_header_size (abfd
);
4724 if (phdr_size
== (bfd_size_type
) -1)
4725 phdr_size
= get_program_header_size (abfd
, info
);
4726 phdr_size
+= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
4727 maxpagesize
= bed
->maxpagesize
;
4728 if (maxpagesize
== 0)
4730 phdr_in_segment
= info
!= NULL
&& info
->load_phdrs
;
4732 && (((sections
[0]->lma
& addr_mask
) & (maxpagesize
- 1))
4733 >= (phdr_size
& (maxpagesize
- 1))))
4734 /* For compatibility with old scripts that may not be using
4735 SIZEOF_HEADERS, add headers when it looks like space has
4736 been left for them. */
4737 phdr_in_segment
= TRUE
;
4739 /* Build the mapping. */
4743 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4744 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4746 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".interp");
4747 if (s
!= NULL
&& (s
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0 && s
->size
!= 0)
4749 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
4750 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
4754 m
->p_type
= PT_PHDR
;
4756 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
4757 m
->includes_phdrs
= 1;
4758 phdr_in_segment
= TRUE
;
4762 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
4763 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
4767 m
->p_type
= PT_INTERP
;
4775 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4776 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4777 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4783 dynsec
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".dynamic");
4785 && (dynsec
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) == 0)
4788 if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) == 0)
4789 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4791 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4792 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4793 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4794 program headers we will need. */
4795 if (phdr_in_segment
&& count
> 0)
4798 bfd_boolean separate_phdr
= FALSE
;
4800 phdr_lma
= (sections
[0]->lma
- phdr_size
) & addr_mask
& -maxpagesize
;
4802 && info
->separate_code
4803 && (sections
[0]->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0)
4805 /* If data sections should be separate from code and
4806 thus not executable, and the first section is
4807 executable then put the file and program headers in
4808 their own PT_LOAD. */
4809 separate_phdr
= TRUE
;
4810 if ((((phdr_lma
+ phdr_size
- 1) & addr_mask
& -maxpagesize
)
4811 == (sections
[0]->lma
& addr_mask
& -maxpagesize
)))
4813 /* The file and program headers are currently on the
4814 same page as the first section. Put them on the
4815 previous page if we can. */
4816 if (phdr_lma
>= maxpagesize
)
4817 phdr_lma
-= maxpagesize
;
4819 separate_phdr
= FALSE
;
4822 if ((sections
[0]->lma
& addr_mask
) < phdr_lma
4823 || (sections
[0]->lma
& addr_mask
) < phdr_size
)
4824 /* If file and program headers would be placed at the end
4825 of memory then it's probably better to omit them. */
4826 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4827 else if (phdr_lma
< wrap_to
)
4828 /* If a section wraps around to where we'll be placing
4829 file and program headers, then the headers will be
4831 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4832 else if (separate_phdr
)
4834 m
= make_mapping (abfd
, sections
, 0, 0, phdr_in_segment
);
4837 m
->p_paddr
= phdr_lma
;
4839 = (sections
[0]->vma
- phdr_size
) & addr_mask
& -maxpagesize
;
4840 m
->p_paddr_valid
= 1;
4843 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4847 for (i
= 0, hdrpp
= sections
; i
< count
; i
++, hdrpp
++)
4850 bfd_boolean new_segment
;
4854 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4857 if (last_hdr
== NULL
)
4859 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4860 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4861 new_segment
= FALSE
;
4863 else if (last_hdr
->lma
- last_hdr
->vma
!= hdr
->lma
- hdr
->vma
)
4865 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4866 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4870 else if (hdr
->lma
< last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
4871 || last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
< last_hdr
->lma
)
4873 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4874 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4877 else if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0
4878 && (((last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
- 1) & -maxpagesize
)
4879 == (hdr
->lma
& -maxpagesize
)))
4881 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4882 pages onto the same memory page. */
4883 new_segment
= FALSE
;
4885 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4886 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4887 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4888 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4889 section can be included in the current segment. */
4890 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
, maxpagesize
)
4891 + maxpagesize
> last_hdr
->lma
)
4892 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr
->lma
+ last_size
, maxpagesize
)
4893 + maxpagesize
<= hdr
->lma
))
4895 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4896 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4899 else if ((last_hdr
->flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)) == 0
4900 && (hdr
->flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)) != 0)
4902 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4903 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4904 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4905 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4908 else if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) == 0)
4910 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4911 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4912 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4913 new_segment
= FALSE
;
4915 else if (info
!= NULL
4916 && info
->separate_code
4917 && executable
!= ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0))
4922 && (hdr
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
4924 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4930 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4931 new_segment
= FALSE
;
4934 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4935 if (last_hdr
!= NULL
4937 && info
->callbacks
->override_segment_assignment
!= NULL
)
4939 = info
->callbacks
->override_segment_assignment (info
, abfd
, hdr
,
4945 if ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
4947 if ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0)
4950 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4951 last_size
= !IS_TBSS (hdr
) ? hdr
->size
: 0;
4955 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4956 header holding all the sections from hdr_index until hdr. */
4958 m
= make_mapping (abfd
, sections
, hdr_index
, i
, phdr_in_segment
);
4965 if ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
4970 if ((hdr
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) == 0)
4976 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4977 last_size
= !IS_TBSS (hdr
) ? hdr
->size
: 0;
4979 phdr_in_segment
= FALSE
;
4982 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4984 if (last_hdr
!= NULL
4985 && (i
- hdr_index
!= 1
4986 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr
)))
4988 m
= make_mapping (abfd
, sections
, hdr_index
, i
, phdr_in_segment
);
4996 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4999 m
= _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd
, dynsec
);
5006 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable SHT_NOTE sections,
5007 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
5008 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
5009 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
5010 in the output file. */
5011 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
5013 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0
5014 && elf_section_type (s
) == SHT_NOTE
)
5017 unsigned int alignment_power
= s
->alignment_power
;
5020 for (s2
= s
; s2
->next
!= NULL
; s2
= s2
->next
)
5022 if (s2
->next
->alignment_power
== alignment_power
5023 && (s2
->next
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0
5024 && elf_section_type (s2
->next
) == SHT_NOTE
5025 && align_power (s2
->lma
+ s2
->size
,
5032 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
5033 amt
+= count
* sizeof (asection
*);
5034 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5038 m
->p_type
= PT_NOTE
;
5042 m
->sections
[m
->count
- count
--] = s
;
5043 BFD_ASSERT ((s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) == 0);
5046 m
->sections
[m
->count
- 1] = s
;
5047 BFD_ASSERT ((s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) == 0);
5051 if (s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)
5057 if (first_mbind
== NULL
5058 && (elf_section_flags (s
) & SHF_GNU_MBIND
) != 0)
5062 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
5065 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
5066 amt
+= tls_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
5067 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5072 m
->count
= tls_count
;
5073 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5075 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
5077 for (i
= 0; i
< (unsigned int) tls_count
; ++i
)
5079 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) == 0)
5082 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd
);
5085 while (i
< (unsigned int) tls_count
)
5087 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
) != 0)
5089 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s
);
5093 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s
);
5096 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
5108 && (abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0
5109 && (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
) != 0)
5110 for (s
= first_mbind
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
5111 if ((elf_section_flags (s
) & SHF_GNU_MBIND
) != 0
5112 && elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
<= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM
)
5114 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5115 unsigned long p_flags
= PF_R
;
5116 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_READONLY
) == 0)
5118 if ((s
->flags
& SEC_CODE
) != 0)
5121 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) + sizeof (asection
*);
5122 m
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5126 m
->p_type
= (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5127 + elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
);
5129 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
5131 m
->p_flags
= p_flags
;
5137 s
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
,
5138 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME
);
5139 if (s
!= NULL
&& s
->size
!= 0)
5141 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) + sizeof (asection
*);
5142 m
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5146 m
->p_type
= PT_GNU_PROPERTY
;
5148 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
5155 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5157 eh_frame_hdr
= elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd
);
5158 if (eh_frame_hdr
!= NULL
5159 && (eh_frame_hdr
->output_section
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0)
5161 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
5162 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5166 m
->p_type
= PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
;
5168 m
->sections
[0] = eh_frame_hdr
->output_section
;
5174 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd
))
5176 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
5177 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5181 m
->p_type
= PT_GNU_STACK
;
5182 m
->p_flags
= elf_stack_flags (abfd
);
5183 m
->p_align
= bed
->stack_align
;
5184 m
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
5185 m
->p_align_valid
= m
->p_align
!= 0;
5186 if (info
->stacksize
> 0)
5188 m
->p_size
= info
->stacksize
;
5189 m
->p_size_valid
= 1;
5196 if (info
!= NULL
&& info
->relro
)
5198 for (m
= mfirst
; m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
5200 if (m
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5202 && m
->sections
[0]->vma
>= info
->relro_start
5203 && m
->sections
[0]->vma
< info
->relro_end
)
5206 while (--i
!= (unsigned) -1)
5207 if ((m
->sections
[i
]->flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
))
5208 == (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
))
5211 if (i
!= (unsigned) -1)
5216 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5219 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
);
5220 m
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, amt
);
5224 m
->p_type
= PT_GNU_RELRO
;
5231 elf_seg_map (abfd
) = mfirst
;
5234 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd
, info
, no_user_phdrs
))
5237 for (count
= 0, m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
); m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
5239 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = count
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5244 if (sections
!= NULL
)
5249 /* Sort sections by address. */
5252 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1
, const void *arg2
)
5254 const asection
*sec1
= *(const asection
**) arg1
;
5255 const asection
*sec2
= *(const asection
**) arg2
;
5256 bfd_size_type size1
, size2
;
5258 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5259 place the section into a segment. */
5260 if (sec1
->lma
< sec2
->lma
)
5262 else if (sec1
->lma
> sec2
->lma
)
5265 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5266 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5267 if (sec1
->vma
< sec2
->vma
)
5269 else if (sec1
->vma
> sec2
->vma
)
5272 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5274 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5281 else if (TOEND (sec2
))
5286 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5287 before others at the same address. */
5289 size1
= (sec1
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) ? sec1
->size
: 0;
5290 size2
= (sec2
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) ? sec2
->size
: 0;
5297 return sec1
->target_index
- sec2
->target_index
;
5300 /* This qsort comparison functions sorts PT_LOAD segments first and
5301 by p_paddr, for assign_file_positions_for_load_sections. */
5304 elf_sort_segments (const void *arg1
, const void *arg2
)
5306 const struct elf_segment_map
*m1
= *(const struct elf_segment_map
**) arg1
;
5307 const struct elf_segment_map
*m2
= *(const struct elf_segment_map
**) arg2
;
5309 if (m1
->p_type
!= m2
->p_type
)
5311 if (m1
->p_type
== PT_NULL
)
5313 if (m2
->p_type
== PT_NULL
)
5315 return m1
->p_type
< m2
->p_type
? -1 : 1;
5317 if (m1
->includes_filehdr
!= m2
->includes_filehdr
)
5318 return m1
->includes_filehdr
? -1 : 1;
5319 if (m1
->no_sort_lma
!= m2
->no_sort_lma
)
5320 return m1
->no_sort_lma
? -1 : 1;
5321 if (m1
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& !m1
->no_sort_lma
)
5325 if (m1
->p_paddr_valid
)
5327 else if (m1
->count
!= 0)
5328 lma1
= m1
->sections
[0]->lma
+ m1
->p_vaddr_offset
;
5330 if (m2
->p_paddr_valid
)
5332 else if (m2
->count
!= 0)
5333 lma2
= m2
->sections
[0]->lma
+ m2
->p_vaddr_offset
;
5335 return lma1
< lma2
? -1 : 1;
5337 if (m1
->idx
!= m2
->idx
)
5338 return m1
->idx
< m2
->idx
? -1 : 1;
5342 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5344 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5345 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5346 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5347 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5348 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5351 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5352 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5354 /* In other words, something like:
5356 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5357 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5358 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5359 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5361 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5363 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5366 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma
, ufile_ptr off
, bfd_vma maxpagesize
)
5368 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5369 if (maxpagesize
== 0)
5371 return ((vma
- off
) % maxpagesize
);
5375 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map
*m
)
5378 const char *pt
= get_segment_type (m
->p_type
);
5383 if (m
->p_type
>= PT_LOPROC
&& m
->p_type
<= PT_HIPROC
)
5384 sprintf (buf
, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5385 (unsigned int) (m
->p_type
- PT_LOPROC
));
5386 else if (m
->p_type
>= PT_LOOS
&& m
->p_type
<= PT_HIOS
)
5387 sprintf (buf
, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5388 (unsigned int) (m
->p_type
- PT_LOOS
));
5390 snprintf (buf
, sizeof (buf
), "%8.8x",
5391 (unsigned int) m
->p_type
);
5395 fprintf (stderr
, "%s:", pt
);
5396 for (j
= 0; j
< m
->count
; j
++)
5397 fprintf (stderr
, " %s", m
->sections
[j
]->name
);
5403 write_zeros (bfd
*abfd
, file_ptr pos
, bfd_size_type len
)
5408 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, pos
, SEEK_SET
) != 0)
5410 buf
= bfd_zmalloc (len
);
5413 ret
= bfd_bwrite (buf
, len
, abfd
) == len
;
5418 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5419 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5423 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd
*abfd
,
5424 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
5426 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
5427 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
5428 struct elf_segment_map
*phdr_load_seg
;
5429 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*phdrs
;
5430 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*p
;
5432 bfd_size_type maxpagesize
;
5433 unsigned int alloc
, actual
;
5435 struct elf_segment_map
**sorted_seg_map
;
5437 if (link_info
== NULL
5438 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd
, link_info
))
5442 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
); m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
5447 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phoff
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5448 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phentsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5452 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5453 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phoff
= 0;
5454 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phentsize
= 0;
5457 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
= alloc
;
5459 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd
) == (bfd_size_type
) -1)
5462 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = alloc
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5466 actual
= elf_program_header_size (abfd
) / bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5467 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd
)
5468 == actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
);
5469 BFD_ASSERT (actual
>= alloc
);
5474 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5478 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5479 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5480 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5481 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5482 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5484 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5485 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5486 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5487 phdrs
= bfd_zalloc (abfd
, (actual
* sizeof (*phdrs
)
5488 + alloc
* sizeof (*sorted_seg_map
)));
5489 sorted_seg_map
= (struct elf_segment_map
**) (phdrs
+ actual
);
5490 elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
= phdrs
;
5494 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
), j
= 0; m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
, j
++)
5496 sorted_seg_map
[j
] = m
;
5497 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5498 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5499 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5500 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5501 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5503 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_type
== ET_CORE
5504 && m
->p_type
== PT_NOTE
))
5506 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5507 m
->sections
[i
]->target_index
= i
;
5508 qsort (m
->sections
, (size_t) m
->count
, sizeof (asection
*),
5513 qsort (sorted_seg_map
, alloc
, sizeof (*sorted_seg_map
),
5517 if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0)
5518 maxpagesize
= bed
->maxpagesize
;
5520 /* Sections must map to file offsets past the ELF file header. */
5521 off
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5522 /* And if one of the PT_LOAD headers doesn't include the program
5523 headers then we'll be mapping program headers in the usual
5524 position after the ELF file header. */
5525 phdr_load_seg
= NULL
;
5526 for (j
= 0; j
< alloc
; j
++)
5528 m
= sorted_seg_map
[j
];
5529 if (m
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
)
5531 if (m
->includes_phdrs
)
5537 if (phdr_load_seg
== NULL
)
5538 off
+= actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5540 for (j
= 0; j
< alloc
; j
++)
5544 bfd_boolean no_contents
;
5546 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5547 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5548 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5549 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5550 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5551 m
= sorted_seg_map
[j
];
5553 p
->p_type
= m
->p_type
;
5554 p
->p_flags
= m
->p_flags
;
5557 p
->p_vaddr
= m
->p_vaddr_offset
;
5559 p
->p_vaddr
= m
->sections
[0]->vma
+ m
->p_vaddr_offset
;
5561 if (m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5562 p
->p_paddr
= m
->p_paddr
;
5563 else if (m
->count
== 0)
5566 p
->p_paddr
= m
->sections
[0]->lma
+ m
->p_vaddr_offset
;
5568 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5569 && (abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0)
5571 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5572 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5573 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5574 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5575 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5576 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5577 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5579 if (m
->p_align_valid
)
5580 maxpagesize
= m
->p_align
;
5582 p
->p_align
= maxpagesize
;
5584 else if (m
->p_align_valid
)
5585 p
->p_align
= m
->p_align
;
5586 else if (m
->count
== 0)
5587 p
->p_align
= 1 << bed
->s
->log_file_align
;
5589 if (m
== phdr_load_seg
)
5591 if (!m
->includes_filehdr
)
5593 off
+= actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5596 no_contents
= FALSE
;
5598 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5601 bfd_size_type align
;
5602 unsigned int align_power
= 0;
5604 if (m
->p_align_valid
)
5608 for (i
= 0, secpp
= m
->sections
; i
< m
->count
; i
++, secpp
++)
5610 unsigned int secalign
;
5612 secalign
= bfd_section_alignment (*secpp
);
5613 if (secalign
> align_power
)
5614 align_power
= secalign
;
5616 align
= (bfd_size_type
) 1 << align_power
;
5617 if (align
< maxpagesize
)
5618 align
= maxpagesize
;
5621 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5622 if ((m
->sections
[i
]->flags
& (SEC_LOAD
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
)) == 0)
5623 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5624 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5625 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5626 elf_section_type (m
->sections
[i
]) = SHT_NOBITS
;
5628 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5631 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5632 if (elf_section_type (m
->sections
[i
]) != SHT_NOBITS
)
5634 no_contents
= FALSE
;
5638 off_adjust
= vma_page_aligned_bias (p
->p_vaddr
, off
, align
);
5640 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5641 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5644 && (abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0
5645 && bed
->no_page_alias
5646 && (off
& (maxpagesize
- 1)) != 0
5647 && (off
& -maxpagesize
) == ((off
+ off_adjust
) & -maxpagesize
))
5648 off_adjust
+= maxpagesize
;
5652 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5653 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5654 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5655 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5656 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5657 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5658 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5659 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5664 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5665 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5666 else if (p
->p_type
== PT_DYNAMIC
5668 && strcmp (m
->sections
[0]->name
, ".dynamic") != 0)
5671 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5672 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5674 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
5677 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5678 else if (p
->p_type
== PT_NOTE
)
5679 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5680 elf_section_type (m
->sections
[i
]) = SHT_NOTE
;
5682 if (m
->includes_filehdr
)
5684 if (!m
->p_flags_valid
)
5686 p
->p_filesz
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5687 p
->p_memsz
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5688 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
5692 if (p
->p_vaddr
< (bfd_vma
) off
5693 || (!m
->p_paddr_valid
5694 && p
->p_paddr
< (bfd_vma
) off
))
5697 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5698 " try linking with -N"),
5700 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
5704 if (!m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5708 else if (sorted_seg_map
[0]->includes_filehdr
)
5710 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*filehdr
= phdrs
+ sorted_seg_map
[0]->idx
;
5711 p
->p_vaddr
= filehdr
->p_vaddr
;
5712 if (!m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5713 p
->p_paddr
= filehdr
->p_paddr
;
5717 if (m
->includes_phdrs
)
5719 if (!m
->p_flags_valid
)
5721 p
->p_filesz
+= actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5722 p
->p_memsz
+= actual
* bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
5723 if (!m
->includes_filehdr
)
5725 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
5727 elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phoff
= p
->p_offset
;
5730 p
->p_vaddr
-= off
- p
->p_offset
;
5731 if (!m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5732 p
->p_paddr
-= off
- p
->p_offset
;
5735 else if (phdr_load_seg
!= NULL
)
5737 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*phdr
= phdrs
+ phdr_load_seg
->idx
;
5738 bfd_vma phdr_off
= 0;
5739 if (phdr_load_seg
->includes_filehdr
)
5740 phdr_off
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5741 p
->p_vaddr
= phdr
->p_vaddr
+ phdr_off
;
5742 if (!m
->p_paddr_valid
)
5743 p
->p_paddr
= phdr
->p_paddr
+ phdr_off
;
5744 p
->p_offset
= phdr
->p_offset
+ phdr_off
;
5747 p
->p_offset
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
5751 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5752 || (p
->p_type
== PT_NOTE
&& bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
))
5754 if (!m
->includes_filehdr
&& !m
->includes_phdrs
)
5760 adjust
= off
- (p
->p_offset
+ p
->p_filesz
);
5762 p
->p_filesz
+= adjust
;
5763 p
->p_memsz
+= adjust
;
5767 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5768 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5769 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5770 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5771 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5772 for (i
= 0, secpp
= m
->sections
; i
< m
->count
; i
++, secpp
++)
5775 bfd_size_type align
;
5776 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
5779 this_hdr
= &elf_section_data (sec
)->this_hdr
;
5780 align
= (bfd_size_type
) 1 << bfd_section_alignment (sec
);
5782 if ((p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
5783 || p
->p_type
== PT_TLS
)
5784 && (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
5785 || ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0
5786 && ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) == 0
5787 || p
->p_type
== PT_TLS
))))
5789 bfd_vma p_start
= p
->p_paddr
;
5790 bfd_vma p_end
= p_start
+ p
->p_memsz
;
5791 bfd_vma s_start
= sec
->lma
;
5792 bfd_vma adjust
= s_start
- p_end
;
5796 || p_end
< p_start
))
5799 /* xgettext:c-format */
5800 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64
" adjusted to %#" PRIx64
),
5801 abfd
, sec
, (uint64_t) s_start
, (uint64_t) p_end
);
5805 p
->p_memsz
+= adjust
;
5807 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
5809 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
5811 if (p
->p_filesz
+ adjust
< p
->p_memsz
)
5813 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5814 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5816 adjust
= p
->p_memsz
- p
->p_filesz
;
5817 if (!write_zeros (abfd
, off
, adjust
))
5822 p
->p_filesz
+= adjust
;
5826 if (p
->p_type
== PT_NOTE
&& bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
)
5828 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5832 this_hdr
->sh_offset
= sec
->filepos
= off
;
5833 off
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5834 p
->p_filesz
= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5840 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5849 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
5851 this_hdr
->sh_offset
= sec
->filepos
= off
;
5852 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
5853 off
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5855 else if (this_hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
5856 && (this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) != 0
5857 && this_hdr
->sh_offset
== 0)
5859 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5860 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5861 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5862 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5863 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5864 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5866 bfd_vma adjust
= vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr
->sh_addr
,
5868 this_hdr
->sh_offset
= sec
->filepos
= off
+ adjust
;
5871 if (this_hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
5873 p
->p_filesz
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5874 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5875 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5876 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5877 if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
5878 p
->p_memsz
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5880 else if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
5882 if (p
->p_type
== PT_TLS
)
5883 p
->p_memsz
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5885 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5887 else if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_TLS
) == 0)
5888 p
->p_memsz
+= this_hdr
->sh_size
;
5891 if (align
> p
->p_align
5892 && !m
->p_align_valid
5893 && (p
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
5894 || (abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) == 0))
5898 if (!m
->p_flags_valid
)
5901 if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_EXECINSTR
) != 0)
5903 if ((this_hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_WRITE
) != 0)
5910 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if
5911 present, will be loaded into memory. */
5912 if (p
->p_type
== PT_PHDR
5913 && phdr_load_seg
== NULL
5914 && !(bed
->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr
!= NULL
5915 && bed
->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd
, phdrs
, alloc
)))
5917 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
5918 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
5919 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
5920 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
5921 " by LOAD segment"),
5926 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5927 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5928 if (p
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& bfd_get_format (abfd
) != bfd_core
)
5930 bfd_boolean check_vma
= TRUE
;
5932 for (i
= 1; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5933 if (m
->sections
[i
]->vma
== m
->sections
[i
- 1]->vma
5934 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m
->sections
[i
])
5935 ->this_hdr
), p
) != 0
5936 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m
->sections
[i
- 1])
5937 ->this_hdr
), p
) != 0)
5939 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5944 for (i
= 0; i
< m
->count
; i
++)
5946 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
5949 sec
= m
->sections
[i
];
5950 this_hdr
= &(elf_section_data(sec
)->this_hdr
);
5951 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr
, p
, check_vma
, 0)
5952 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr
, p
))
5955 /* xgettext:c-format */
5956 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5958 print_segment_map (m
);
5964 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
5966 if (link_info
!= NULL
5967 && phdr_load_seg
!= NULL
5968 && phdr_load_seg
->includes_filehdr
)
5970 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5971 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5972 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5974 struct elf_link_hash_entry
*hash
5975 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info
), "__ehdr_start",
5976 FALSE
, FALSE
, TRUE
);
5977 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5979 && (hash
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_new
5980 || hash
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_undefined
5981 || hash
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5982 || hash
->root
.type
== bfd_link_hash_common
))
5985 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr
= phdrs
[phdr_load_seg
->idx
].p_vaddr
;
5987 if (phdr_load_seg
->count
!= 0)
5988 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5989 s
= phdr_load_seg
->sections
[0];
5991 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5992 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
); m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
5993 if (m
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& m
->count
!= 0)
6001 hash
->root
.u
.def
.value
= filehdr_vaddr
- s
->vma
;
6002 hash
->root
.u
.def
.section
= s
;
6006 hash
->root
.u
.def
.value
= filehdr_vaddr
;
6007 hash
->root
.u
.def
.section
= bfd_abs_section_ptr
;
6010 hash
->root
.type
= bfd_link_hash_defined
;
6011 hash
->def_regular
= 1;
6019 /* Determine if a bfd is a debuginfo file. Unfortunately there
6020 is no defined method for detecting such files, so we have to
6021 use heuristics instead. */
6024 is_debuginfo_file (bfd
*abfd
)
6026 if (abfd
== NULL
|| bfd_get_flavour (abfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
6029 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**start_headers
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6030 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**end_headers
= start_headers
+ elf_numsections (abfd
);
6031 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**headerp
;
6033 for (headerp
= start_headers
; headerp
< end_headers
; headerp
++)
6035 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*header
= * headerp
;
6037 /* Debuginfo files do not have any allocated SHT_PROGBITS sections.
6038 The only allocated sections are SHT_NOBITS or SHT_NOTES. */
6039 if ((header
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) == SHF_ALLOC
6040 && header
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
6041 && header
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOTE
)
6048 /* Assign file positions for the other sections, except for compressed debugging
6049 and other sections assigned in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load(). */
6052 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd
*abfd
,
6053 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
6055 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6056 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**i_shdrpp
;
6057 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**hdrpp
, **end_hdrpp
;
6058 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*phdrs
;
6059 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*p
;
6060 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
6063 i_shdrpp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6064 end_hdrpp
= i_shdrpp
+ elf_numsections (abfd
);
6065 off
= elf_next_file_pos (abfd
);
6066 for (hdrpp
= i_shdrpp
+ 1; hdrpp
< end_hdrpp
; hdrpp
++)
6068 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
6071 if (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
6072 && (hdr
->bfd_section
->filepos
!= 0
6073 || (hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_NOBITS
6074 && hdr
->contents
== NULL
)))
6075 BFD_ASSERT (hdr
->sh_offset
== hdr
->bfd_section
->filepos
);
6076 else if ((hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_ALLOC
) != 0)
6078 if (hdr
->sh_size
!= 0
6079 /* PR 24717 - debuginfo files are known to be not strictly
6080 compliant with the ELF standard. In particular they often
6081 have .note.gnu.property sections that are outside of any
6082 loadable segment. This is not a problem for such files,
6083 so do not warn about them. */
6084 && ! is_debuginfo_file (abfd
))
6086 /* xgettext:c-format */
6087 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
6089 (hdr
->bfd_section
== NULL
6091 : hdr
->bfd_section
->name
));
6092 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
6093 if ((abfd
->flags
& D_PAGED
) != 0 && hdr
->sh_size
!= 0)
6094 off
+= vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr
->sh_addr
, off
,
6097 off
+= vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr
->sh_addr
, off
,
6099 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
,
6102 else if (((hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_REL
|| hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
6103 && hdr
->bfd_section
== NULL
)
6104 /* We don't know the offset of these sections yet: their size has
6105 not been decided. */
6106 || (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
6107 && (hdr
->bfd_section
->flags
& SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6108 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr
->bfd_section
)
6109 && abfd
->is_linker_output
)))
6110 || hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_onesymtab (abfd
)]
6111 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) != NULL
6112 && hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->ndx
])
6113 || hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_strtab_sec (abfd
)]
6114 || hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
)])
6115 hdr
->sh_offset
= -1;
6117 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
6119 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
6121 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
6122 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
6123 phdrs
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
;
6124 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
), p
= phdrs
; m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
, p
++)
6126 if (p
->p_type
== PT_GNU_RELRO
)
6131 if (link_info
!= NULL
)
6133 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
6134 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
6135 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
6136 start
= link_info
->relro_start
;
6137 end
= link_info
->relro_end
;
6139 else if (m
->count
!= 0)
6141 if (!m
->p_size_valid
)
6143 start
= m
->sections
[0]->vma
;
6144 end
= start
+ m
->p_size
;
6155 struct elf_segment_map
*lm
;
6156 const Elf_Internal_Phdr
*lp
;
6159 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
6161 for (lm
= elf_seg_map (abfd
), lp
= phdrs
;
6163 lm
= lm
->next
, lp
++)
6165 if (lp
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
6167 && (lm
->sections
[lm
->count
- 1]->vma
6168 + (!IS_TBSS (lm
->sections
[lm
->count
- 1])
6169 ? lm
->sections
[lm
->count
- 1]->size
6171 && lm
->sections
[0]->vma
< end
)
6177 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
6178 for (i
= 0; i
< lm
->count
; i
++)
6180 asection
*s
= lm
->sections
[i
];
6189 p
->p_vaddr
= lm
->sections
[i
]->vma
;
6190 p
->p_paddr
= lm
->sections
[i
]->lma
;
6191 p
->p_offset
= lm
->sections
[i
]->filepos
;
6192 p
->p_memsz
= end
- p
->p_vaddr
;
6193 p
->p_filesz
= p
->p_memsz
;
6195 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
6196 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
6197 In cases where the end does not match any
6198 loaded section (for instance is in file
6199 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
6200 the end of loaded section contents. */
6201 if (p
->p_filesz
> lp
->p_vaddr
+ lp
->p_filesz
- p
->p_vaddr
)
6202 p
->p_filesz
= lp
->p_vaddr
+ lp
->p_filesz
- p
->p_vaddr
;
6204 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
6205 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
6206 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
6207 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
6208 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
6210 if (!m
->p_align_valid
)
6212 if (!m
->p_flags_valid
)
6218 if (link_info
!= NULL
)
6221 memset (p
, 0, sizeof *p
);
6223 else if (p
->p_type
== PT_GNU_STACK
)
6225 if (m
->p_size_valid
)
6226 p
->p_memsz
= m
->p_size
;
6228 else if (m
->count
!= 0)
6232 if (p
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
6233 && (p
->p_type
!= PT_NOTE
6234 || bfd_get_format (abfd
) != bfd_core
))
6236 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
6237 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
6238 if (p
->p_type
== PT_PHDR
)
6244 if (m
->includes_filehdr
|| m
->includes_phdrs
)
6246 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6248 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6249 "and/or program header"),
6250 abfd
, (int) (p
- phdrs
));
6255 p
->p_offset
= m
->sections
[0]->filepos
;
6256 for (i
= m
->count
; i
-- != 0;)
6258 asection
*sect
= m
->sections
[i
];
6259 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
= &elf_section_data (sect
)->this_hdr
;
6260 if (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_NOBITS
)
6262 p
->p_filesz
= (sect
->filepos
- m
->sections
[0]->filepos
6274 static elf_section_list
*
6275 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i
, elf_section_list
* list
)
6277 for (;list
!= NULL
; list
= list
->next
)
6283 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6284 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6285 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6287 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6288 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and those that
6289 bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are stored in a normal
6290 bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't consider the former sort
6291 here, unless they form part of the loadable image. Reloc sections not
6292 assigned here (and compressed debugging sections and CTF sections which
6293 nothing else in the file can rely upon) will be handled later by
6294 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6296 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6299 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd
*abfd
,
6300 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
6302 struct elf_obj_tdata
*tdata
= elf_tdata (abfd
);
6303 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
6304 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6307 if ((abfd
->flags
& (EXEC_P
| DYNAMIC
)) == 0
6308 && bfd_get_format (abfd
) != bfd_core
)
6310 Elf_Internal_Shdr
** const i_shdrpp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6311 unsigned int num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
6312 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**hdrpp
;
6316 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6317 off
= i_ehdrp
->e_ehsize
;
6319 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6320 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6321 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6322 for (i
= 1, hdrpp
= i_shdrpp
+ 1; i
< num_sec
; i
++, hdrpp
++)
6324 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
6327 if (((hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_REL
|| hdr
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
)
6328 && hdr
->bfd_section
== NULL
)
6329 /* Do not assign offsets for these sections yet: we don't know
6331 || (hdr
->bfd_section
!= NULL
6332 && (hdr
->bfd_section
->flags
& SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6333 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr
->bfd_section
)
6334 && abfd
->is_linker_output
)))
6335 || i
== elf_onesymtab (abfd
)
6336 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
) != NULL
6337 && hdr
== i_shdrpp
[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->ndx
])
6338 || i
== elf_strtab_sec (abfd
)
6339 || i
== elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
))
6341 hdr
->sh_offset
= -1;
6344 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr
, off
, TRUE
);
6347 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
6348 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = 0;
6352 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6353 assignment of sections to segments. */
6354 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd
, link_info
))
6357 /* And for non-load sections. */
6358 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd
, link_info
))
6362 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_modify_headers
) (abfd
, link_info
))
6365 /* Write out the program headers. */
6366 alloc
= i_ehdrp
->e_phnum
;
6369 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, i_ehdrp
->e_phoff
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
6370 || bed
->s
->write_out_phdrs (abfd
, tdata
->phdr
, alloc
) != 0)
6378 _bfd_elf_init_file_header (bfd
*abfd
,
6379 struct bfd_link_info
*info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
6381 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6382 struct elf_strtab_hash
*shstrtab
;
6383 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6385 i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
6387 shstrtab
= _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6388 if (shstrtab
== NULL
)
6391 elf_shstrtab (abfd
) = shstrtab
;
6393 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_MAG0
] = ELFMAG0
;
6394 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_MAG1
] = ELFMAG1
;
6395 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_MAG2
] = ELFMAG2
;
6396 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_MAG3
] = ELFMAG3
;
6398 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
] = bed
->s
->elfclass
;
6399 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_DATA
] =
6400 bfd_big_endian (abfd
) ? ELFDATA2MSB
: ELFDATA2LSB
;
6401 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_VERSION
] = bed
->s
->ev_current
;
6403 if ((abfd
->flags
& DYNAMIC
) != 0)
6404 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_DYN
;
6405 else if ((abfd
->flags
& EXEC_P
) != 0)
6406 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_EXEC
;
6407 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_core
)
6408 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_CORE
;
6410 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_REL
;
6412 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd
))
6414 case bfd_arch_unknown
:
6415 i_ehdrp
->e_machine
= EM_NONE
;
6418 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6419 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6420 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6421 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6422 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6423 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6424 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6425 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6427 i_ehdrp
->e_machine
= bed
->elf_machine_code
;
6430 i_ehdrp
->e_version
= bed
->s
->ev_current
;
6431 i_ehdrp
->e_ehsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
6433 /* No program header, for now. */
6434 i_ehdrp
->e_phoff
= 0;
6435 i_ehdrp
->e_phentsize
= 0;
6436 i_ehdrp
->e_phnum
= 0;
6438 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6439 i_ehdrp
->e_entry
= bfd_get_start_address (abfd
);
6440 i_ehdrp
->e_shentsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_shdr
;
6442 elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
.sh_name
=
6443 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab
, ".symtab", FALSE
);
6444 elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
.sh_name
=
6445 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab
, ".strtab", FALSE
);
6446 elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
.sh_name
=
6447 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab
, ".shstrtab", FALSE
);
6448 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
.sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1
6449 || elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
.sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1
6450 || elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
.sh_name
== (unsigned int) -1)
6456 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=.
6458 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6459 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6460 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6461 changed or the programs updated. */
6464 _bfd_elf_modify_headers (bfd
*obfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
6466 if (link_info
!= NULL
&& bfd_link_pie (link_info
))
6468 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (obfd
);
6469 unsigned int num_segments
= i_ehdrp
->e_phnum
;
6470 struct elf_obj_tdata
*tdata
= elf_tdata (obfd
);
6471 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
= tdata
->phdr
;
6472 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*end_segment
= &segment
[num_segments
];
6474 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6475 bfd_vma p_vaddr
= (bfd_vma
) -1;
6476 for (; segment
< end_segment
; segment
++)
6477 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& p_vaddr
> segment
->p_vaddr
)
6478 p_vaddr
= segment
->p_vaddr
;
6480 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6481 segments is non-zero. */
6483 i_ehdrp
->e_type
= ET_EXEC
;
6488 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6489 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6492 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd
*abfd
)
6495 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**shdrpp
, **end_shdrpp
;
6496 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*shdrp
;
6497 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
;
6498 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
6500 off
= elf_next_file_pos (abfd
);
6502 shdrpp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6503 end_shdrpp
= shdrpp
+ elf_numsections (abfd
);
6504 for (shdrpp
++; shdrpp
< end_shdrpp
; shdrpp
++)
6507 if (shdrp
->sh_offset
== -1)
6509 asection
*sec
= shdrp
->bfd_section
;
6510 bfd_boolean is_rel
= (shdrp
->sh_type
== SHT_REL
6511 || shdrp
->sh_type
== SHT_RELA
);
6512 bfd_boolean is_ctf
= sec
&& bfd_section_is_ctf (sec
);
6515 || (sec
!= NULL
&& (sec
->flags
& SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
)))
6517 if (!is_rel
&& !is_ctf
)
6519 const char *name
= sec
->name
;
6520 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*d
;
6522 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6523 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd
, sec
,
6527 if (sec
->compress_status
== COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6528 && (abfd
->flags
& BFD_COMPRESS_GABI
) == 0)
6530 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6531 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6533 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd
, name
);
6534 if (new_name
== NULL
)
6538 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6539 if (shdrp
->sh_name
!= (unsigned int) -1)
6542 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd
),
6544 d
= elf_section_data (sec
);
6546 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6548 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd
,
6553 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd
,
6558 /* Update section size and contents. */
6559 shdrp
->sh_size
= sec
->size
;
6560 shdrp
->contents
= sec
->contents
;
6561 shdrp
->bfd_section
->contents
= NULL
;
6565 /* Update section size and contents. */
6566 shdrp
->sh_size
= sec
->size
;
6567 shdrp
->contents
= sec
->contents
;
6570 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp
,
6577 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6579 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd
));
6580 shdrp
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->shstrtab_hdr
;
6581 shdrp
->sh_size
= _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd
));
6582 off
= _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp
, off
, TRUE
);
6584 /* Place the section headers. */
6585 i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
6586 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6587 off
= align_file_position (off
, 1 << bed
->s
->log_file_align
);
6588 i_ehdrp
->e_shoff
= off
;
6589 off
+= i_ehdrp
->e_shnum
* i_ehdrp
->e_shentsize
;
6590 elf_next_file_pos (abfd
) = off
;
6596 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd
*abfd
)
6598 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6599 Elf_Internal_Shdr
**i_shdrp
;
6601 unsigned int count
, num_sec
;
6602 struct elf_obj_tdata
*t
;
6604 if (! abfd
->output_has_begun
6605 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd
, NULL
))
6607 /* Do not rewrite ELF data when the BFD has been opened for update.
6608 abfd->output_has_begun was set to TRUE on opening, so creation of new
6609 sections, and modification of existing section sizes was restricted.
6610 This means the ELF header, program headers and section headers can't have
6612 If the contents of any sections has been modified, then those changes have
6613 already been written to the BFD. */
6614 else if (abfd
->direction
== both_direction
)
6616 BFD_ASSERT (abfd
->output_has_begun
);
6620 i_shdrp
= elf_elfsections (abfd
);
6623 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd
, bed
->s
->write_relocs
, &failed
);
6627 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd
))
6630 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6631 num_sec
= elf_numsections (abfd
);
6632 for (count
= 1; count
< num_sec
; count
++)
6634 i_shdrp
[count
]->sh_name
6635 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd
),
6636 i_shdrp
[count
]->sh_name
);
6637 if (bed
->elf_backend_section_processing
)
6638 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_section_processing
) (abfd
, i_shdrp
[count
]))
6640 if (i_shdrp
[count
]->contents
)
6642 bfd_size_type amt
= i_shdrp
[count
]->sh_size
;
6644 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, i_shdrp
[count
]->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
6645 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp
[count
]->contents
, amt
, abfd
) != amt
)
6650 /* Write out the section header names. */
6651 t
= elf_tdata (abfd
);
6652 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd
) != NULL
6653 && (bfd_seek (abfd
, t
->shstrtab_hdr
.sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
6654 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd
, elf_shstrtab (abfd
))))
6657 if (!(*bed
->elf_backend_final_write_processing
) (abfd
))
6660 if (!bed
->s
->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd
))
6663 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6664 if (t
->o
->build_id
.after_write_object_contents
!= NULL
)
6665 return (*t
->o
->build_id
.after_write_object_contents
) (abfd
);
6671 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd
*abfd
)
6673 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6674 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd
);
6677 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6680 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_section
*asect
)
6682 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
6683 unsigned int sec_index
;
6685 if (elf_section_data (asect
) != NULL
6686 && elf_section_data (asect
)->this_idx
!= 0)
6687 return elf_section_data (asect
)->this_idx
;
6689 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect
))
6690 sec_index
= SHN_ABS
;
6691 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect
))
6692 sec_index
= SHN_COMMON
;
6693 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect
))
6694 sec_index
= SHN_UNDEF
;
6696 sec_index
= SHN_BAD
;
6698 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
6699 if (bed
->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section
)
6701 int retval
= sec_index
;
6703 if ((*bed
->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section
) (abfd
, asect
, &retval
))
6707 if (sec_index
== SHN_BAD
)
6708 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section
);
6713 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6717 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
**asym_ptr_ptr
)
6719 asymbol
*asym_ptr
= *asym_ptr_ptr
;
6721 flagword flags
= asym_ptr
->flags
;
6723 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6724 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6725 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6726 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6727 input sections rather than the output section. */
6728 if (asym_ptr
->udata
.i
== 0
6729 && (flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
)
6730 && asym_ptr
->section
)
6735 sec
= asym_ptr
->section
;
6736 if (sec
->owner
!= abfd
&& sec
->output_section
!= NULL
)
6737 sec
= sec
->output_section
;
6738 if (sec
->owner
== abfd
6739 && (indx
= sec
->index
) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd
)
6740 && elf_section_syms (abfd
)[indx
] != NULL
)
6741 asym_ptr
->udata
.i
= elf_section_syms (abfd
)[indx
]->udata
.i
;
6744 idx
= asym_ptr
->udata
.i
;
6748 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6749 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6751 /* xgettext:c-format */
6752 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6753 abfd
, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr
));
6754 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols
);
6761 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6762 (long) asym_ptr
, asym_ptr
->name
, idx
, flags
);
6770 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6773 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
6775 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*iehdr
;
6776 struct elf_segment_map
*map
;
6777 struct elf_segment_map
*map_first
;
6778 struct elf_segment_map
**pointer_to_map
;
6779 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
;
6782 unsigned int num_segments
;
6783 bfd_boolean phdr_included
= FALSE
;
6784 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid
;
6785 bfd_vma maxpagesize
;
6786 struct elf_segment_map
*phdr_adjust_seg
= NULL
;
6787 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num
= 0;
6788 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
6790 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (ibfd
);
6791 iehdr
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
);
6794 pointer_to_map
= &map_first
;
6796 num_segments
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_phnum
;
6797 maxpagesize
= get_elf_backend_data (obfd
)->maxpagesize
;
6799 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6800 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6801 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6802 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6804 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6805 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6806 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6807 ? section->size : 0)
6809 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6810 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6811 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6812 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6813 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6814 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6816 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6817 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6818 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6819 (section->lma >= base \
6820 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) >= section->lma) \
6821 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6822 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6824 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6825 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6826 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6827 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6828 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6829 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6830 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6832 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6834 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6836 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6840 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6841 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6842 p_memsz set to 0. */
6843 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6845 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6846 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6847 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6848 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6850 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6851 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6852 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6854 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6855 A section will be included if:
6856 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6857 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6858 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6860 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6861 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6862 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6863 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6864 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6865 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6866 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6867 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6868 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6869 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6870 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6871 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6872 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6873 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6874 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6875 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6876 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6877 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6878 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6879 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6880 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6881 || (segment->p_paddr \
6882 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6883 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6884 || (strcmp (bfd_section_name (section), ".dynamic") == 0)) \
6885 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6887 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6888 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6889 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6890 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6891 && section->output_section != NULL)
6893 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6894 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6895 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6897 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6898 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6899 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6900 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6901 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6903 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6904 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6905 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6906 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6907 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6909 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6910 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
; section
!= NULL
; section
= section
->next
)
6911 section
->segment_mark
= FALSE
;
6913 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6914 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6915 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6916 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6917 p_paddr_valid
= FALSE
;
6918 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
6921 if (segment
->p_paddr
!= 0)
6923 p_paddr_valid
= TRUE
;
6927 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6928 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6929 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6930 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6931 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
6936 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment2
;
6938 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_INTERP
)
6939 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
; section
; section
= section
->next
)
6940 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment
, section
))
6942 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6943 assignment code will work. */
6944 segment
->p_vaddr
= section
->vma
;
6948 if (segment
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
)
6950 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6951 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_GNU_RELRO
)
6952 segment
->p_type
= PT_NULL
;
6956 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6957 for (j
= 0, segment2
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
; j
< i
; j
++, segment2
++)
6959 bfd_signed_vma extra_length
;
6961 if (segment2
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
6962 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment
, segment2
))
6965 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6966 if (segment2
->p_vaddr
< segment
->p_vaddr
)
6968 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6970 extra_length
= (SEGMENT_END (segment
, segment
->p_vaddr
)
6971 - SEGMENT_END (segment2
, segment2
->p_vaddr
));
6973 if (extra_length
> 0)
6975 segment2
->p_memsz
+= extra_length
;
6976 segment2
->p_filesz
+= extra_length
;
6979 segment
->p_type
= PT_NULL
;
6981 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6983 segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
6988 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6990 extra_length
= (SEGMENT_END (segment2
, segment2
->p_vaddr
)
6991 - SEGMENT_END (segment
, segment
->p_vaddr
));
6993 if (extra_length
> 0)
6995 segment
->p_memsz
+= extra_length
;
6996 segment
->p_filesz
+= extra_length
;
6999 segment2
->p_type
= PT_NULL
;
7004 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
7005 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7009 unsigned int section_count
;
7010 asection
**sections
;
7011 asection
*output_section
;
7013 asection
*matching_lma
;
7014 asection
*suggested_lma
;
7017 asection
*first_section
;
7019 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_NULL
)
7022 first_section
= NULL
;
7023 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
7024 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
, section_count
= 0;
7026 section
= section
->next
)
7028 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
7029 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
7030 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section
, segment
, bed
))
7032 if (first_section
== NULL
)
7033 first_section
= section
;
7034 if (section
->output_section
!= NULL
)
7039 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7040 all of the sections we have selected. */
7041 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
7042 amt
+= (bfd_size_type
) section_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
7043 map
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (obfd
, amt
);
7047 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
7048 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
7050 map
->p_type
= segment
->p_type
;
7051 map
->p_flags
= segment
->p_flags
;
7052 map
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
7054 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
7055 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
7057 if (!first_section
|| first_section
->output_section
!= NULL
)
7059 map
->p_paddr
= segment
->p_paddr
;
7060 map
->p_paddr_valid
= p_paddr_valid
;
7063 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7064 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7065 map
->includes_filehdr
= (segment
->p_offset
== 0
7066 && segment
->p_filesz
>= iehdr
->e_ehsize
);
7067 map
->includes_phdrs
= 0;
7069 if (!phdr_included
|| segment
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
)
7071 map
->includes_phdrs
=
7072 (segment
->p_offset
<= (bfd_vma
) iehdr
->e_phoff
7073 && (segment
->p_offset
+ segment
->p_filesz
7074 >= ((bfd_vma
) iehdr
->e_phoff
7075 + iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
)));
7077 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& map
->includes_phdrs
)
7078 phdr_included
= TRUE
;
7081 if (section_count
== 0)
7083 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
7084 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
7085 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
7086 a warning is produced.
7087 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
7088 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
7089 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
7090 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
7091 && (segment
->p_filesz
> 0 || segment
->p_memsz
== 0))
7092 /* xgettext:c-format */
7094 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
7095 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64
", is this intentional?"),
7096 ibfd
, (uint64_t) segment
->p_vaddr
);
7098 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= segment
->p_vaddr
;
7100 *pointer_to_map
= map
;
7101 pointer_to_map
= &map
->next
;
7106 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
7107 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
7108 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
7109 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
7111 1. None of the sections have been moved.
7112 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
7115 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
7116 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7117 of the first section.
7119 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
7120 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
7121 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
7122 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
7123 have to be created to contain the other sections.
7125 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
7126 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7127 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
7128 or segments to contain the other sections.
7130 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
7131 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
7132 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
7134 sections
= (asection
**) bfd_malloc2 (section_count
, sizeof (asection
*));
7135 if (sections
== NULL
)
7138 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
7139 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
7140 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
7141 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
7142 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
7145 matching_lma
= NULL
;
7146 suggested_lma
= NULL
;
7148 for (section
= first_section
, j
= 0;
7150 section
= section
->next
)
7152 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section
, segment
, bed
))
7154 output_section
= section
->output_section
;
7156 sections
[j
++] = section
;
7158 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
7159 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
7160 correct value. Note - some backends require that
7161 p_paddr be left as zero. */
7163 && segment
->p_vaddr
!= 0
7164 && !bed
->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7166 && output_section
->lma
!= 0
7167 && (align_power (segment
->p_vaddr
7168 + (map
->includes_filehdr
7169 ? iehdr
->e_ehsize
: 0)
7170 + (map
->includes_phdrs
7171 ? iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
7173 output_section
->alignment_power
)
7174 == output_section
->vma
))
7175 map
->p_paddr
= segment
->p_vaddr
;
7177 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
7178 LMA address of the output section. */
7179 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section
, segment
, map
->p_paddr
)
7180 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment
, section
)
7181 || (bed
->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7182 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section
, segment
)))
7184 if (matching_lma
== NULL
7185 || output_section
->lma
< matching_lma
->lma
)
7186 matching_lma
= output_section
;
7188 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
7189 then it does not overlap any other section within that
7191 map
->sections
[isec
++] = output_section
;
7193 else if (suggested_lma
== NULL
)
7194 suggested_lma
= output_section
;
7196 if (j
== section_count
)
7201 BFD_ASSERT (j
== section_count
);
7203 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
7205 if (isec
== section_count
)
7207 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
7208 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
7209 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
7210 program header in the input BFD. */
7211 map
->count
= section_count
;
7212 *pointer_to_map
= map
;
7213 pointer_to_map
= &map
->next
;
7216 && !bed
->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
)
7218 bfd_vma hdr_size
= 0;
7219 if (map
->includes_filehdr
)
7220 hdr_size
= iehdr
->e_ehsize
;
7221 if (map
->includes_phdrs
)
7222 hdr_size
+= iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
;
7224 /* Account for padding before the first section in the
7226 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= map
->p_paddr
+ hdr_size
- matching_lma
->lma
;
7234 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7235 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7236 section fitted, the first section. */
7237 if (matching_lma
== NULL
)
7238 matching_lma
= suggested_lma
;
7240 map
->p_paddr
= matching_lma
->lma
;
7242 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7243 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7244 if (map
->includes_phdrs
)
7246 map
->p_paddr
-= iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
;
7248 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7249 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7250 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7251 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7252 offset when we know the correct value. */
7253 phdr_adjust_num
= iehdr
->e_phnum
;
7254 phdr_adjust_seg
= map
;
7257 if (map
->includes_filehdr
)
7259 bfd_vma align
= (bfd_vma
) 1 << matching_lma
->alignment_power
;
7260 map
->p_paddr
-= iehdr
->e_ehsize
;
7261 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7262 first section lma, but there may have been some
7263 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7264 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7265 the same alignment. */
7266 if (segment
->p_align
!= 0 && segment
->p_align
< align
)
7267 align
= segment
->p_align
;
7268 map
->p_paddr
&= -align
;
7272 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7273 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7274 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7275 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7276 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7277 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7283 suggested_lma
= NULL
;
7285 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7286 for (j
= 0; j
< section_count
; j
++)
7288 section
= sections
[j
];
7290 if (section
== NULL
)
7293 output_section
= section
->output_section
;
7295 BFD_ASSERT (output_section
!= NULL
);
7297 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section
, segment
, map
->p_paddr
)
7298 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment
, section
))
7300 if (map
->count
== 0)
7302 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7303 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7305 if (align_power (map
->p_paddr
7306 + (map
->includes_filehdr
7307 ? iehdr
->e_ehsize
: 0)
7308 + (map
->includes_phdrs
7309 ? iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
7311 output_section
->alignment_power
)
7312 != output_section
->lma
)
7319 prev_sec
= map
->sections
[map
->count
- 1];
7321 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7322 and the start of this section is more than
7323 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7324 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec
->lma
+ prev_sec
->size
,
7326 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section
->lma
, maxpagesize
))
7327 || (prev_sec
->lma
+ prev_sec
->size
7328 > output_section
->lma
))
7330 if (suggested_lma
== NULL
)
7331 suggested_lma
= output_section
;
7337 map
->sections
[map
->count
++] = output_section
;
7340 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
)
7341 section
->segment_mark
= TRUE
;
7343 else if (suggested_lma
== NULL
)
7344 suggested_lma
= output_section
;
7347 /* PR 23932. A corrupt input file may contain sections that cannot
7348 be assigned to any segment - because for example they have a
7349 negative size - or segments that do not contain any sections. */
7350 if (map
->count
== 0)
7353 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry
);
7358 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7359 *pointer_to_map
= map
;
7360 pointer_to_map
= &map
->next
;
7362 if (isec
< section_count
)
7364 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7365 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7366 and carry on looping. */
7367 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
7368 amt
+= (bfd_size_type
) section_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
7369 map
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (obfd
, amt
);
7376 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7377 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7378 not yet been assigned. */
7380 map
->p_type
= segment
->p_type
;
7381 map
->p_flags
= segment
->p_flags
;
7382 map
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
7383 map
->p_paddr
= suggested_lma
->lma
;
7384 map
->p_paddr_valid
= p_paddr_valid
;
7385 map
->includes_filehdr
= 0;
7386 map
->includes_phdrs
= 0;
7389 while (isec
< section_count
);
7394 elf_seg_map (obfd
) = map_first
;
7396 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7397 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7398 the offset if necessary. */
7399 if (phdr_adjust_seg
!= NULL
)
7403 for (count
= 0, map
= map_first
; map
!= NULL
; map
= map
->next
)
7406 if (count
> phdr_adjust_num
)
7407 phdr_adjust_seg
->p_paddr
7408 -= (count
- phdr_adjust_num
) * iehdr
->e_phentsize
;
7410 for (map
= map_first
; map
!= NULL
; map
= map
->next
)
7411 if (map
->p_type
== PT_PHDR
)
7414 = phdr_adjust_seg
->includes_filehdr
? iehdr
->e_ehsize
: 0;
7415 map
->p_paddr
= phdr_adjust_seg
->p_paddr
+ adjust
;
7422 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7423 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7425 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7426 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7427 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7428 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7429 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7430 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7434 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7437 copy_elf_program_header (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
7439 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*iehdr
;
7440 struct elf_segment_map
*map
;
7441 struct elf_segment_map
*map_first
;
7442 struct elf_segment_map
**pointer_to_map
;
7443 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
;
7445 unsigned int num_segments
;
7446 bfd_boolean phdr_included
= FALSE
;
7447 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid
;
7449 iehdr
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
);
7452 pointer_to_map
= &map_first
;
7454 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7455 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7456 p_paddr_valid
= FALSE
;
7457 num_segments
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_phnum
;
7458 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7461 if (segment
->p_paddr
!= 0)
7463 p_paddr_valid
= TRUE
;
7467 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7472 unsigned int section_count
;
7474 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
7475 asection
*first_section
= NULL
;
7476 asection
*lowest_section
;
7478 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7479 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
, section_count
= 0;
7481 section
= section
->next
)
7483 this_hdr
= &(elf_section_data(section
)->this_hdr
);
7484 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr
, segment
))
7486 if (first_section
== NULL
)
7487 first_section
= section
;
7492 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7493 all of the sections we have selected. */
7494 amt
= sizeof (struct elf_segment_map
) - sizeof (asection
*);
7495 amt
+= (bfd_size_type
) section_count
* sizeof (asection
*);
7496 map
= (struct elf_segment_map
*) bfd_zalloc (obfd
, amt
);
7500 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7503 map
->p_type
= segment
->p_type
;
7504 map
->p_flags
= segment
->p_flags
;
7505 map
->p_flags_valid
= 1;
7506 map
->p_paddr
= segment
->p_paddr
;
7507 map
->p_paddr_valid
= p_paddr_valid
;
7508 map
->p_align
= segment
->p_align
;
7509 map
->p_align_valid
= 1;
7510 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= 0;
7512 if (map
->p_type
== PT_GNU_RELRO
7513 || map
->p_type
== PT_GNU_STACK
)
7515 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7516 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7517 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7518 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7519 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7521 map
->p_size
= segment
->p_memsz
;
7522 map
->p_size_valid
= 1;
7525 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7526 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7527 map
->includes_filehdr
= (segment
->p_offset
== 0
7528 && segment
->p_filesz
>= iehdr
->e_ehsize
);
7530 map
->includes_phdrs
= 0;
7531 if (! phdr_included
|| segment
->p_type
!= PT_LOAD
)
7533 map
->includes_phdrs
=
7534 (segment
->p_offset
<= (bfd_vma
) iehdr
->e_phoff
7535 && (segment
->p_offset
+ segment
->p_filesz
7536 >= ((bfd_vma
) iehdr
->e_phoff
7537 + iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
)));
7539 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
&& map
->includes_phdrs
)
7540 phdr_included
= TRUE
;
7543 lowest_section
= NULL
;
7544 if (section_count
!= 0)
7546 unsigned int isec
= 0;
7548 for (section
= first_section
;
7550 section
= section
->next
)
7552 this_hdr
= &(elf_section_data(section
)->this_hdr
);
7553 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr
, segment
))
7555 map
->sections
[isec
++] = section
->output_section
;
7556 if ((section
->flags
& SEC_ALLOC
) != 0)
7560 if (lowest_section
== NULL
7561 || section
->lma
< lowest_section
->lma
)
7562 lowest_section
= section
;
7564 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7565 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7566 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7567 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7569 if ((section
->flags
& SEC_LOAD
) != 0)
7570 seg_off
= this_hdr
->sh_offset
- segment
->p_offset
;
7572 seg_off
= this_hdr
->sh_addr
- segment
->p_vaddr
;
7573 if (section
->lma
- segment
->p_paddr
!= seg_off
)
7574 map
->p_paddr_valid
= FALSE
;
7576 if (isec
== section_count
)
7582 if (section_count
== 0)
7583 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= segment
->p_vaddr
;
7584 else if (map
->p_paddr_valid
)
7586 /* Account for padding before the first section in the segment. */
7587 bfd_vma hdr_size
= 0;
7588 if (map
->includes_filehdr
)
7589 hdr_size
= iehdr
->e_ehsize
;
7590 if (map
->includes_phdrs
)
7591 hdr_size
+= iehdr
->e_phnum
* iehdr
->e_phentsize
;
7593 map
->p_vaddr_offset
= (map
->p_paddr
+ hdr_size
7594 - (lowest_section
? lowest_section
->lma
: 0));
7597 map
->count
= section_count
;
7598 *pointer_to_map
= map
;
7599 pointer_to_map
= &map
->next
;
7602 elf_seg_map (obfd
) = map_first
;
7606 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7610 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
7612 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7613 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7616 if (elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
== NULL
)
7619 if (ibfd
->xvec
== obfd
->xvec
)
7621 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7622 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7623 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
;
7624 asection
*section
, *osec
;
7625 unsigned int i
, num_segments
;
7626 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*this_hdr
;
7627 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
7629 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (ibfd
);
7631 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7632 if (bed
->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
)
7635 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7636 for (section
= obfd
->sections
; section
!= NULL
;
7637 section
= section
->next
)
7638 section
->segment_mark
= FALSE
;
7640 num_segments
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_phnum
;
7641 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7645 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7646 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7647 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7648 map in this case. */
7649 if (segment
->p_paddr
== 0
7650 && segment
->p_memsz
== 0
7651 && (segment
->p_type
== PT_INTERP
|| segment
->p_type
== PT_DYNAMIC
))
7654 for (section
= ibfd
->sections
;
7655 section
!= NULL
; section
= section
->next
)
7657 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7658 from the input BFD. */
7659 osec
= section
->output_section
;
7661 osec
->segment_mark
= TRUE
;
7663 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7664 this_hdr
= &(elf_section_data(section
)->this_hdr
);
7665 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr
, segment
))
7667 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7668 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7670 || section
->flags
!= osec
->flags
7671 || section
->lma
!= osec
->lma
7672 || section
->vma
!= osec
->vma
7673 || section
->size
!= osec
->size
7674 || section
->rawsize
!= osec
->rawsize
7675 || section
->alignment_power
!= osec
->alignment_power
)
7681 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7683 for (section
= obfd
->sections
; section
!= NULL
;
7684 section
= section
->next
)
7686 if (!section
->segment_mark
)
7689 section
->segment_mark
= FALSE
;
7692 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd
, obfd
);
7696 if (ibfd
->xvec
== obfd
->xvec
)
7698 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7699 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7700 Elf_Internal_Phdr
*segment
;
7702 unsigned int num_segments
= elf_elfheader (ibfd
)->e_phnum
;
7703 bfd_vma maxpagesize
= 0;
7705 for (i
= 0, segment
= elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
;
7708 if (segment
->p_type
== PT_LOAD
7709 && maxpagesize
< segment
->p_align
)
7711 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7712 if (segment
->p_align
> (bfd_vma
) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma
) * 8) - 2))
7713 /* xgettext:c-format */
7714 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7715 PRIx64
" is too large"),
7716 ibfd
, (uint64_t) segment
->p_align
);
7718 maxpagesize
= segment
->p_align
;
7721 if (maxpagesize
!= get_elf_backend_data (obfd
)->maxpagesize
)
7722 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd
), maxpagesize
);
7725 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd
, obfd
);
7728 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7731 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd
*ibfd
,
7735 struct bfd_link_info
*link_info
)
7738 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*ihdr
, *ohdr
;
7739 bfd_boolean final_link
= (link_info
!= NULL
7740 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info
));
7742 if (ibfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
7743 || obfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7746 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec
) != NULL
);
7748 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7749 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7750 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7751 that the linker clears to differ. */
7752 if (elf_section_type (osec
) == SHT_NULL
7753 && (osec
->flags
== isec
->flags
7755 && ((osec
->flags
^ isec
->flags
)
7756 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE
| SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES
| SEC_RELOC
)) == 0)))
7757 elf_section_type (osec
) = elf_section_type (isec
);
7759 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7760 elf_section_flags (osec
) |= (elf_section_flags (isec
)
7761 & (SHF_MASKOS
| SHF_MASKPROC
));
7763 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7764 if ((elf_tdata (ibfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
) != 0
7765 && elf_section_flags (isec
) & SHF_GNU_MBIND
)
7766 elf_section_data (osec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
7767 = elf_section_data (isec
)->this_hdr
.sh_info
;
7769 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7770 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7771 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7772 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7773 if ((link_info
== NULL
7774 || !link_info
->resolve_section_groups
)
7775 && (elf_sec_group (isec
) == NULL
7776 || (elf_sec_group (isec
)->flags
& SEC_LINKER_CREATED
) == 0))
7778 if (elf_section_flags (isec
) & SHF_GROUP
)
7779 elf_section_flags (osec
) |= SHF_GROUP
;
7780 elf_next_in_group (osec
) = elf_next_in_group (isec
);
7781 elf_section_data (osec
)->group
= elf_section_data (isec
)->group
;
7784 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7785 if (!final_link
&& (ibfd
->flags
& BFD_DECOMPRESS
) == 0)
7786 elf_section_flags (osec
) |= (elf_section_flags (isec
)
7789 ihdr
= &elf_section_data (isec
)->this_hdr
;
7791 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7792 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7793 may be NULL at this point. */
7794 if ((ihdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_LINK_ORDER
) != 0)
7796 ohdr
= &elf_section_data (osec
)->this_hdr
;
7797 ohdr
->sh_flags
|= SHF_LINK_ORDER
;
7798 elf_linked_to_section (osec
) = elf_linked_to_section (isec
);
7801 osec
->use_rela_p
= isec
->use_rela_p
;
7806 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7807 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7810 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd
*ibfd
,
7815 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*ihdr
, *ohdr
;
7817 if (ibfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
7818 || obfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7821 ihdr
= &elf_section_data (isec
)->this_hdr
;
7822 ohdr
= &elf_section_data (osec
)->this_hdr
;
7824 ohdr
->sh_entsize
= ihdr
->sh_entsize
;
7826 if (ihdr
->sh_type
== SHT_SYMTAB
7827 || ihdr
->sh_type
== SHT_DYNSYM
7828 || ihdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GNU_verneed
7829 || ihdr
->sh_type
== SHT_GNU_verdef
)
7830 ohdr
->sh_info
= ihdr
->sh_info
;
7832 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd
, isec
, obfd
, osec
,
7836 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7837 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7838 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7839 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7840 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7844 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd
*ibfd
, asection
*discarded
)
7848 for (isec
= ibfd
->sections
; isec
!= NULL
; isec
= isec
->next
)
7849 if (elf_section_type (isec
) == SHT_GROUP
)
7851 asection
*first
= elf_next_in_group (isec
);
7852 asection
*s
= first
;
7853 bfd_size_type removed
= 0;
7857 /* If this member section is being output but the
7858 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7859 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7860 if (s
->output_section
!= discarded
7861 && isec
->output_section
== discarded
)
7863 elf_section_flags (s
->output_section
) &= ~SHF_GROUP
;
7864 elf_group_name (s
->output_section
) = NULL
;
7866 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7867 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7868 else if (s
->output_section
== discarded
7869 && isec
->output_section
!= discarded
)
7871 struct bfd_elf_section_data
*elf_sec
= elf_section_data (s
);
7873 if (elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
!= NULL
7874 && (elf_sec
->rel
.hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
) != 0)
7876 if (elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
!= NULL
7877 && (elf_sec
->rela
.hdr
->sh_flags
& SHF_GROUP
) != 0)
7880 s
= elf_next_in_group (s
);
7886 if (discarded
!= NULL
)
7888 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7889 adjust the input section size. */
7890 if (isec
->rawsize
== 0)
7891 isec
->rawsize
= isec
->size
;
7892 isec
->size
= isec
->rawsize
- removed
;
7893 if (isec
->size
<= 4)
7896 isec
->flags
|= SEC_EXCLUDE
;
7901 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7903 isec
->output_section
->size
-= removed
;
7904 if (isec
->output_section
->size
<= 4)
7906 isec
->output_section
->size
= 0;
7907 isec
->output_section
->flags
|= SEC_EXCLUDE
;
7916 /* Copy private header information. */
7919 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd
*ibfd
, bfd
*obfd
)
7921 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7922 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7925 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7926 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7927 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7928 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7929 already been worked out. */
7930 if (elf_seg_map (obfd
) == NULL
&& elf_tdata (ibfd
)->phdr
!= NULL
)
7932 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd
, obfd
))
7936 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd
, NULL
);
7939 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7940 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7941 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7942 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7943 swap_out_syms function. */
7945 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7946 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7947 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7948 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7949 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7952 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd
*ibfd
,
7957 elf_symbol_type
*isym
, *osym
;
7959 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7960 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd
) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
7963 isym
= elf_symbol_from (ibfd
, isymarg
);
7964 osym
= elf_symbol_from (obfd
, osymarg
);
7967 && isym
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
!= 0
7969 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym
->symbol
.section
))
7973 shndx
= isym
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
;
7974 if (shndx
== elf_onesymtab (ibfd
))
7975 shndx
= MAP_ONESYMTAB
;
7976 else if (shndx
== elf_dynsymtab (ibfd
))
7977 shndx
= MAP_DYNSYMTAB
;
7978 else if (shndx
== elf_strtab_sec (ibfd
))
7980 else if (shndx
== elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd
))
7981 shndx
= MAP_SHSTRTAB
;
7982 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx
, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd
)))
7983 shndx
= MAP_SYM_SHNDX
;
7984 osym
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
= shndx
;
7990 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7993 swap_out_syms (bfd
*abfd
,
7994 struct elf_strtab_hash
**sttp
,
7997 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
;
8000 struct elf_strtab_hash
*stt
;
8001 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_hdr
;
8002 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symtab_shndx_hdr
;
8003 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*symstrtab_hdr
;
8004 struct elf_sym_strtab
*symstrtab
;
8005 bfd_byte
*outbound_syms
;
8006 bfd_byte
*outbound_shndx
;
8007 unsigned long outbound_syms_index
;
8008 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index
;
8010 unsigned int num_locals
;
8012 bfd_boolean name_local_sections
;
8014 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd
, &num_locals
))
8017 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
8018 stt
= _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
8022 bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
8023 symcount
= bfd_get_symcount (abfd
);
8024 symtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
;
8025 symtab_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_SYMTAB
;
8026 symtab_hdr
->sh_entsize
= bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
;
8027 symtab_hdr
->sh_size
= symtab_hdr
->sh_entsize
* (symcount
+ 1);
8028 symtab_hdr
->sh_info
= num_locals
+ 1;
8029 symtab_hdr
->sh_addralign
= (bfd_vma
) 1 << bed
->s
->log_file_align
;
8031 symstrtab_hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->strtab_hdr
;
8032 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_STRTAB
;
8034 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
8035 symstrtab
= (struct elf_sym_strtab
*) bfd_malloc2 (symcount
+ 1,
8036 sizeof (*symstrtab
));
8037 if (symstrtab
== NULL
)
8039 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt
);
8043 outbound_syms
= (bfd_byte
*) bfd_alloc2 (abfd
, 1 + symcount
,
8044 bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
);
8045 if (outbound_syms
== NULL
)
8048 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt
);
8052 symtab_hdr
->contents
= outbound_syms
;
8053 outbound_syms_index
= 0;
8055 outbound_shndx
= NULL
;
8056 outbound_shndx_index
= 0;
8058 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
))
8060 symtab_shndx_hdr
= & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->hdr
;
8061 if (symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_name
!= 0)
8063 amt
= (bfd_size_type
) (1 + symcount
) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
);
8064 outbound_shndx
= (bfd_byte
*)
8065 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd
, 1 + symcount
, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
));
8066 if (outbound_shndx
== NULL
)
8069 symtab_shndx_hdr
->contents
= outbound_shndx
;
8070 symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
;
8071 symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_size
= amt
;
8072 symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_addralign
= sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
);
8073 symtab_shndx_hdr
->sh_entsize
= sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
);
8075 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
8078 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
8080 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
8081 Elf_Internal_Sym sym
;
8087 sym
.st_shndx
= SHN_UNDEF
;
8088 sym
.st_target_internal
= 0;
8089 symstrtab
[0].sym
= sym
;
8090 symstrtab
[0].dest_index
= outbound_syms_index
;
8091 symstrtab
[0].destshndx_index
= outbound_shndx_index
;
8092 outbound_syms_index
++;
8093 if (outbound_shndx
!= NULL
)
8094 outbound_shndx_index
++;
8098 = (bed
->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
8099 && bed
->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd
));
8101 syms
= bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd
);
8102 for (idx
= 0; idx
< symcount
;)
8104 Elf_Internal_Sym sym
;
8105 bfd_vma value
= syms
[idx
]->value
;
8106 elf_symbol_type
*type_ptr
;
8107 flagword flags
= syms
[idx
]->flags
;
8110 if (!name_local_sections
8111 && (flags
& (BSF_SECTION_SYM
| BSF_GLOBAL
)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM
)
8113 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
8114 sym
.st_name
= (unsigned long) -1;
8118 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
8119 to get the final offset for st_name. */
8121 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt
, syms
[idx
]->name
,
8123 if (sym
.st_name
== (unsigned long) -1)
8127 type_ptr
= elf_symbol_from (abfd
, syms
[idx
]);
8129 if ((flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
) == 0
8130 && bfd_is_com_section (syms
[idx
]->section
))
8132 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
8133 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
8134 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
8135 sym
.st_size
= value
;
8136 if (type_ptr
== NULL
8137 || type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_value
== 0)
8138 sym
.st_value
= value
>= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value
));
8140 sym
.st_value
= type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_value
;
8141 sym
.st_shndx
= _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
8142 (abfd
, syms
[idx
]->section
);
8146 asection
*sec
= syms
[idx
]->section
;
8149 if (sec
->output_section
)
8151 value
+= sec
->output_offset
;
8152 sec
= sec
->output_section
;
8155 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
8156 if (! relocatable_p
)
8158 sym
.st_value
= value
;
8159 sym
.st_size
= type_ptr
? type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_size
: 0;
8161 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec
)
8163 && type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
!= 0)
8165 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
8166 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
8167 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
8168 shndx
= type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_shndx
;
8172 shndx
= elf_onesymtab (abfd
);
8175 shndx
= elf_dynsymtab (abfd
);
8178 shndx
= elf_strtab_sec (abfd
);
8181 shndx
= elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd
);
8184 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
))
8185 shndx
= elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd
)->ndx
;
8194 shndx
= _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd
, sec
);
8196 if (shndx
== SHN_BAD
)
8200 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
8201 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
8202 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
8203 demand of applications. For example, it
8204 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
8205 section of a symbol to be a section that is
8206 actually in the output file. */
8207 sec2
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, sec
->name
);
8209 shndx
= _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd
, sec2
);
8210 if (shndx
== SHN_BAD
)
8212 /* xgettext:c-format */
8214 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
8215 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
8216 syms
[idx
]->name
? syms
[idx
]->name
: "<Local sym>",
8218 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
8224 sym
.st_shndx
= shndx
;
8227 if ((flags
& BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
) != 0)
8229 else if ((flags
& BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION
) != 0)
8230 type
= STT_GNU_IFUNC
;
8231 else if ((flags
& BSF_FUNCTION
) != 0)
8233 else if ((flags
& BSF_OBJECT
) != 0)
8235 else if ((flags
& BSF_RELC
) != 0)
8237 else if ((flags
& BSF_SRELC
) != 0)
8242 if (syms
[idx
]->section
->flags
& SEC_THREAD_LOCAL
)
8245 /* Processor-specific types. */
8246 if (type_ptr
!= NULL
8247 && bed
->elf_backend_get_symbol_type
)
8248 type
= ((*bed
->elf_backend_get_symbol_type
)
8249 (&type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
, type
));
8251 if (flags
& BSF_SECTION_SYM
)
8253 if (flags
& BSF_GLOBAL
)
8254 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL
, STT_SECTION
);
8256 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL
, STT_SECTION
);
8258 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms
[idx
]->section
))
8260 if (type
!= STT_TLS
)
8262 if ((abfd
->flags
& BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON
))
8263 type
= ((abfd
->flags
& BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON
)
8264 ? STT_COMMON
: STT_OBJECT
);
8266 type
= ((flags
& BSF_ELF_COMMON
) != 0
8267 ? STT_COMMON
: STT_OBJECT
);
8269 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL
, type
);
8271 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms
[idx
]->section
))
8272 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (((flags
& BSF_WEAK
)
8276 else if (flags
& BSF_FILE
)
8277 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL
, STT_FILE
);
8280 int bind
= STB_LOCAL
;
8282 if (flags
& BSF_LOCAL
)
8284 else if (flags
& BSF_GNU_UNIQUE
)
8285 bind
= STB_GNU_UNIQUE
;
8286 else if (flags
& BSF_WEAK
)
8288 else if (flags
& BSF_GLOBAL
)
8291 sym
.st_info
= ELF_ST_INFO (bind
, type
);
8294 if (type_ptr
!= NULL
)
8296 sym
.st_other
= type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_other
;
8297 sym
.st_target_internal
8298 = type_ptr
->internal_elf_sym
.st_target_internal
;
8303 sym
.st_target_internal
= 0;
8307 symstrtab
[idx
].sym
= sym
;
8308 symstrtab
[idx
].dest_index
= outbound_syms_index
;
8309 symstrtab
[idx
].destshndx_index
= outbound_shndx_index
;
8311 outbound_syms_index
++;
8312 if (outbound_shndx
!= NULL
)
8313 outbound_shndx_index
++;
8316 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8317 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt
);
8319 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8320 for (idx
= 0; idx
<= symcount
; idx
++)
8322 struct elf_sym_strtab
*elfsym
= &symstrtab
[idx
];
8323 if (elfsym
->sym
.st_name
== (unsigned long) -1)
8324 elfsym
->sym
.st_name
= 0;
8326 elfsym
->sym
.st_name
= _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt
,
8327 elfsym
->sym
.st_name
);
8328 bed
->s
->swap_symbol_out (abfd
, &elfsym
->sym
,
8330 + (elfsym
->dest_index
8331 * bed
->s
->sizeof_sym
)),
8333 + (elfsym
->destshndx_index
8334 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx
))));
8339 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_size
= _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt
);
8340 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_type
= SHT_STRTAB
;
8341 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_flags
= bed
->elf_strtab_flags
;
8342 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_addr
= 0;
8343 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_entsize
= 0;
8344 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_link
= 0;
8345 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_info
= 0;
8346 symstrtab_hdr
->sh_addralign
= 1;
8351 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8353 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8354 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8355 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8358 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
)
8360 bfd_size_type symcount
;
8362 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->symtab_hdr
;
8364 symcount
= hdr
->sh_size
/ get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->sizeof_sym
;
8365 if (symcount
>= LONG_MAX
/ sizeof (asymbol
*))
8367 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8370 symtab_size
= (symcount
+ 1) * (sizeof (asymbol
*));
8372 symtab_size
-= sizeof (asymbol
*);
8378 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
)
8380 bfd_size_type symcount
;
8382 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynsymtab_hdr
;
8384 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == 0)
8386 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
8390 symcount
= hdr
->sh_size
/ get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->sizeof_sym
;
8391 if (symcount
>= LONG_MAX
/ sizeof (asymbol
*))
8393 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8396 symtab_size
= (symcount
+ 1) * (sizeof (asymbol
*));
8398 symtab_size
-= sizeof (asymbol
*);
8404 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
8407 #if SIZEOF_LONG == SIZEOF_INT
8408 if (asect
->reloc_count
>= LONG_MAX
/ sizeof (arelent
*))
8410 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8414 return (asect
->reloc_count
+ 1) * sizeof (arelent
*);
8417 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8420 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd
*abfd
,
8427 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
8429 if (! bed
->s
->slurp_reloc_table (abfd
, section
, symbols
, FALSE
))
8432 tblptr
= section
->relocation
;
8433 for (i
= 0; i
< section
->reloc_count
; i
++)
8434 *relptr
++ = tblptr
++;
8438 return section
->reloc_count
;
8442 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
**allocation
)
8444 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
8445 long symcount
= bed
->s
->slurp_symbol_table (abfd
, allocation
, FALSE
);
8448 abfd
->symcount
= symcount
;
8453 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd
*abfd
,
8454 asymbol
**allocation
)
8456 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
8457 long symcount
= bed
->s
->slurp_symbol_table (abfd
, allocation
, TRUE
);
8460 abfd
->dynsymcount
= symcount
;
8464 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8465 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8466 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8467 dynamic reloc section. */
8470 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
)
8472 bfd_size_type count
;
8475 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == 0)
8477 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
8482 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
8483 if (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_link
== elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)
8484 && (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_REL
8485 || elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_RELA
))
8487 count
+= s
->size
/ elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_entsize
;
8488 if (count
> LONG_MAX
/ sizeof (arelent
*))
8490 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big
);
8494 return count
* sizeof (arelent
*);
8497 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8498 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8499 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8500 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8501 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8502 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8503 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8506 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd
*abfd
,
8510 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs
) (bfd
*, asection
*, asymbol
**, bfd_boolean
);
8514 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd
) == 0)
8516 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation
);
8520 slurp_relocs
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->slurp_reloc_table
;
8522 for (s
= abfd
->sections
; s
!= NULL
; s
= s
->next
)
8524 if (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_link
== elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)
8525 && (elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_REL
8526 || elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_type
== SHT_RELA
))
8531 if (! (*slurp_relocs
) (abfd
, s
, syms
, TRUE
))
8533 count
= s
->size
/ elf_section_data (s
)->this_hdr
.sh_entsize
;
8535 for (i
= 0; i
< count
; i
++)
8546 /* Read in the version information. */
8549 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd
*abfd
, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver
)
8551 bfd_byte
*contents
= NULL
;
8552 unsigned int freeidx
= 0;
8554 if (elf_dynverref (abfd
) != 0)
8556 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
8557 Elf_External_Verneed
*everneed
;
8558 Elf_Internal_Verneed
*iverneed
;
8560 bfd_byte
*contents_end
;
8562 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynverref_hdr
;
8564 if (hdr
->sh_info
== 0
8565 || hdr
->sh_info
> hdr
->sh_size
/ sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed
))
8567 error_return_bad_verref
:
8569 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd
);
8570 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
8571 error_return_verref
:
8572 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
= NULL
;
8573 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
= 0;
8577 ufile_ptr filesize
= bfd_get_file_size (abfd
);
8578 if (filesize
> 0 && filesize
< hdr
->sh_size
)
8580 /* PR 24708: Avoid attempts to allocate a ridiculous amount
8582 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory
);
8584 /* xgettext:c-format */
8585 (_("error: %pB version reference section is too large (%#" PRIx64
" bytes)"),
8586 abfd
, (uint64_t) hdr
->sh_size
);
8587 goto error_return_verref
;
8589 contents
= (bfd_byte
*) bfd_malloc (hdr
->sh_size
);
8590 if (contents
== NULL
)
8591 goto error_return_verref
;
8593 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, hdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
8594 || bfd_bread (contents
, hdr
->sh_size
, abfd
) != hdr
->sh_size
)
8595 goto error_return_verref
;
8597 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
= (Elf_Internal_Verneed
*)
8598 bfd_alloc2 (abfd
, hdr
->sh_info
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed
));
8600 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
== NULL
)
8601 goto error_return_verref
;
8603 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed
)
8604 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux
));
8605 contents_end
= contents
+ hdr
->sh_size
- sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed
);
8606 everneed
= (Elf_External_Verneed
*) contents
;
8607 iverneed
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verref
;
8608 for (i
= 0; i
< hdr
->sh_info
; i
++, iverneed
++)
8610 Elf_External_Vernaux
*evernaux
;
8611 Elf_Internal_Vernaux
*ivernaux
;
8614 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd
, everneed
, iverneed
);
8616 iverneed
->vn_bfd
= abfd
;
8618 iverneed
->vn_filename
=
8619 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
,
8621 if (iverneed
->vn_filename
== NULL
)
8622 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8624 if (iverneed
->vn_cnt
== 0)
8625 iverneed
->vn_auxptr
= NULL
;
8628 iverneed
->vn_auxptr
= (struct elf_internal_vernaux
*)
8629 bfd_alloc2 (abfd
, iverneed
->vn_cnt
,
8630 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux
));
8631 if (iverneed
->vn_auxptr
== NULL
)
8632 goto error_return_verref
;
8635 if (iverneed
->vn_aux
8636 > (size_t) (contents_end
- (bfd_byte
*) everneed
))
8637 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8639 evernaux
= ((Elf_External_Vernaux
*)
8640 ((bfd_byte
*) everneed
+ iverneed
->vn_aux
));
8641 ivernaux
= iverneed
->vn_auxptr
;
8642 for (j
= 0; j
< iverneed
->vn_cnt
; j
++, ivernaux
++)
8644 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd
, evernaux
, ivernaux
);
8646 ivernaux
->vna_nodename
=
8647 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
,
8648 ivernaux
->vna_name
);
8649 if (ivernaux
->vna_nodename
== NULL
)
8650 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8652 if (ivernaux
->vna_other
> freeidx
)
8653 freeidx
= ivernaux
->vna_other
;
8655 ivernaux
->vna_nextptr
= NULL
;
8656 if (ivernaux
->vna_next
== 0)
8658 iverneed
->vn_cnt
= j
+ 1;
8661 if (j
+ 1 < iverneed
->vn_cnt
)
8662 ivernaux
->vna_nextptr
= ivernaux
+ 1;
8664 if (ivernaux
->vna_next
8665 > (size_t) (contents_end
- (bfd_byte
*) evernaux
))
8666 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8668 evernaux
= ((Elf_External_Vernaux
*)
8669 ((bfd_byte
*) evernaux
+ ivernaux
->vna_next
));
8672 iverneed
->vn_nextref
= NULL
;
8673 if (iverneed
->vn_next
== 0)
8675 if (i
+ 1 < hdr
->sh_info
)
8676 iverneed
->vn_nextref
= iverneed
+ 1;
8678 if (iverneed
->vn_next
8679 > (size_t) (contents_end
- (bfd_byte
*) everneed
))
8680 goto error_return_bad_verref
;
8682 everneed
= ((Elf_External_Verneed
*)
8683 ((bfd_byte
*) everneed
+ iverneed
->vn_next
));
8685 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverrefs
= i
;
8691 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd
) != 0)
8693 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
8694 Elf_External_Verdef
*everdef
;
8695 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*iverdef
;
8696 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*iverdefarr
;
8697 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem
;
8699 unsigned int maxidx
;
8700 bfd_byte
*contents_end_def
, *contents_end_aux
;
8702 hdr
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dynverdef_hdr
;
8704 if (hdr
->sh_info
== 0 || hdr
->sh_size
< sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef
))
8706 error_return_bad_verdef
:
8708 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd
);
8709 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value
);
8710 error_return_verdef
:
8711 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
= NULL
;
8712 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
= 0;
8716 contents
= (bfd_byte
*) bfd_malloc (hdr
->sh_size
);
8717 if (contents
== NULL
)
8718 goto error_return_verdef
;
8719 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, hdr
->sh_offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
8720 || bfd_bread (contents
, hdr
->sh_size
, abfd
) != hdr
->sh_size
)
8721 goto error_return_verdef
;
8723 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef
)
8724 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux
));
8725 contents_end_def
= contents
+ hdr
->sh_size
8726 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef
);
8727 contents_end_aux
= contents
+ hdr
->sh_size
8728 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux
);
8730 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8731 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8733 everdef
= (Elf_External_Verdef
*) contents
;
8735 for (i
= 0; i
< hdr
->sh_info
; ++i
)
8737 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd
, everdef
, &iverdefmem
);
8739 if ((iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION
)) == 0)
8740 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8741 if ((iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION
)) > maxidx
)
8742 maxidx
= iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION
);
8744 if (iverdefmem
.vd_next
== 0)
8747 if (iverdefmem
.vd_next
8748 > (size_t) (contents_end_def
- (bfd_byte
*) everdef
))
8749 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8751 everdef
= ((Elf_External_Verdef
*)
8752 ((bfd_byte
*) everdef
+ iverdefmem
.vd_next
));
8755 if (default_imported_symver
)
8757 if (freeidx
> maxidx
)
8763 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
= (Elf_Internal_Verdef
*)
8764 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd
, maxidx
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef
));
8765 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
== NULL
)
8766 goto error_return_verdef
;
8768 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
= maxidx
;
8770 everdef
= (Elf_External_Verdef
*) contents
;
8771 iverdefarr
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
;
8772 for (i
= 0; i
< hdr
->sh_info
; i
++)
8774 Elf_External_Verdaux
*everdaux
;
8775 Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*iverdaux
;
8778 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd
, everdef
, &iverdefmem
);
8780 if ((iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& VERSYM_VERSION
) == 0)
8781 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8783 iverdef
= &iverdefarr
[(iverdefmem
.vd_ndx
& VERSYM_VERSION
) - 1];
8784 memcpy (iverdef
, &iverdefmem
, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef
, vd_bfd
));
8786 iverdef
->vd_bfd
= abfd
;
8788 if (iverdef
->vd_cnt
== 0)
8789 iverdef
->vd_auxptr
= NULL
;
8792 iverdef
->vd_auxptr
= (struct elf_internal_verdaux
*)
8793 bfd_alloc2 (abfd
, iverdef
->vd_cnt
,
8794 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux
));
8795 if (iverdef
->vd_auxptr
== NULL
)
8796 goto error_return_verdef
;
8800 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux
- (bfd_byte
*) everdef
))
8801 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8803 everdaux
= ((Elf_External_Verdaux
*)
8804 ((bfd_byte
*) everdef
+ iverdef
->vd_aux
));
8805 iverdaux
= iverdef
->vd_auxptr
;
8806 for (j
= 0; j
< iverdef
->vd_cnt
; j
++, iverdaux
++)
8808 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd
, everdaux
, iverdaux
);
8810 iverdaux
->vda_nodename
=
8811 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd
, hdr
->sh_link
,
8812 iverdaux
->vda_name
);
8813 if (iverdaux
->vda_nodename
== NULL
)
8814 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8816 iverdaux
->vda_nextptr
= NULL
;
8817 if (iverdaux
->vda_next
== 0)
8819 iverdef
->vd_cnt
= j
+ 1;
8822 if (j
+ 1 < iverdef
->vd_cnt
)
8823 iverdaux
->vda_nextptr
= iverdaux
+ 1;
8825 if (iverdaux
->vda_next
8826 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux
- (bfd_byte
*) everdaux
))
8827 goto error_return_bad_verdef
;
8829 everdaux
= ((Elf_External_Verdaux
*)
8830 ((bfd_byte
*) everdaux
+ iverdaux
->vda_next
));
8833 iverdef
->vd_nodename
= NULL
;
8834 if (iverdef
->vd_cnt
)
8835 iverdef
->vd_nodename
= iverdef
->vd_auxptr
->vda_nodename
;
8837 iverdef
->vd_nextdef
= NULL
;
8838 if (iverdef
->vd_next
== 0)
8840 if ((size_t) (iverdef
- iverdefarr
) + 1 < maxidx
)
8841 iverdef
->vd_nextdef
= iverdef
+ 1;
8843 everdef
= ((Elf_External_Verdef
*)
8844 ((bfd_byte
*) everdef
+ iverdef
->vd_next
));
8850 else if (default_imported_symver
)
8857 elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
= (Elf_Internal_Verdef
*)
8858 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd
, freeidx
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef
));
8859 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
== NULL
)
8862 elf_tdata (abfd
)->cverdefs
= freeidx
;
8865 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8866 if (default_imported_symver
)
8868 Elf_Internal_Verdef
*iverdef
;
8869 Elf_Internal_Verdaux
*iverdaux
;
8871 iverdef
= &elf_tdata (abfd
)->verdef
[freeidx
- 1];
8873 iverdef
->vd_version
= VER_DEF_CURRENT
;
8874 iverdef
->vd_flags
= 0;
8875 iverdef
->vd_ndx
= freeidx
;
8876 iverdef
->vd_cnt
= 1;
8878 iverdef
->vd_bfd
= abfd
;
8880 iverdef
->vd_nodename
= bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd
);
8881 if (iverdef
->vd_nodename
== NULL
)
8882 goto error_return_verdef
;
8883 iverdef
->vd_nextdef
= NULL
;
8884 iverdef
->vd_auxptr
= ((struct elf_internal_verdaux
*)
8885 bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux
)));
8886 if (iverdef
->vd_auxptr
== NULL
)
8887 goto error_return_verdef
;
8889 iverdaux
= iverdef
->vd_auxptr
;
8890 iverdaux
->vda_nodename
= iverdef
->vd_nodename
;
8896 if (contents
!= NULL
)
8902 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd
*abfd
)
8904 elf_symbol_type
*newsym
;
8906 newsym
= (elf_symbol_type
*) bfd_zalloc (abfd
, sizeof (*newsym
));
8909 newsym
->symbol
.the_bfd
= abfd
;
8910 return &newsym
->symbol
;
8914 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
8918 bfd_symbol_info (symbol
, ret
);
8921 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8922 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8926 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
8929 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8930 if (name
[0] == '.' && name
[1] == 'L')
8933 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8934 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8935 if (name
[0] == '.' && name
[1] == '.')
8938 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8939 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8940 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8941 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8942 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8943 we treat such symbols as local. */
8944 if (name
[0] == '_' && name
[1] == '.' && name
[2] == 'L' && name
[3] == '_')
8947 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8948 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8949 These labels have the form:
8951 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8953 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8955 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8956 so we only need to match the rest. */
8957 if (name
[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name
[1]))
8959 bfd_boolean ret
= FALSE
;
8963 for (p
= name
+ 2; (c
= *p
); p
++)
8965 if (c
== 1 || c
== 2)
8967 if (c
== 1 && p
== name
+ 2)
8968 /* A fake symbol. */
8971 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8972 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8973 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8974 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8975 other than some kind of local ? */
8992 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
8993 asymbol
*symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
9000 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd
*abfd
,
9001 enum bfd_architecture arch
,
9002 unsigned long machine
)
9004 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
9005 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
9006 if (arch
!= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->arch
9007 && arch
!= bfd_arch_unknown
9008 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->arch
!= bfd_arch_unknown
)
9011 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd
, arch
, machine
);
9014 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
9015 for error reporting. */
9018 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd
*abfd
,
9022 const char **filename_ptr
,
9023 const char **functionname_ptr
,
9024 unsigned int *line_ptr
,
9025 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr
)
9029 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd
, symbols
, NULL
, section
, offset
,
9030 filename_ptr
, functionname_ptr
,
9031 line_ptr
, discriminator_ptr
,
9032 dwarf_debug_sections
,
9033 &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dwarf2_find_line_info
))
9036 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd
, symbols
, section
, offset
,
9037 filename_ptr
, functionname_ptr
, line_ptr
))
9039 if (!*functionname_ptr
)
9040 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd
, symbols
, section
, offset
,
9041 *filename_ptr
? NULL
: filename_ptr
,
9046 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd
, symbols
, section
, offset
,
9047 &found
, filename_ptr
,
9048 functionname_ptr
, line_ptr
,
9049 &elf_tdata (abfd
)->line_info
))
9051 if (found
&& (*functionname_ptr
|| *line_ptr
))
9054 if (symbols
== NULL
)
9057 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd
, symbols
, section
, offset
,
9058 filename_ptr
, functionname_ptr
))
9065 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
9068 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd
*abfd
, asymbol
**symbols
, asymbol
*symbol
,
9069 const char **filename_ptr
, unsigned int *line_ptr
)
9071 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd
, symbols
, symbol
, NULL
, 0,
9072 filename_ptr
, NULL
, line_ptr
, NULL
,
9073 dwarf_debug_sections
,
9074 &elf_tdata (abfd
)->dwarf2_find_line_info
);
9077 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
9078 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
9079 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
9080 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
9081 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
9084 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd
*abfd
,
9085 const char **filename_ptr
,
9086 const char **functionname_ptr
,
9087 unsigned int *line_ptr
)
9090 found
= _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd
, filename_ptr
,
9091 functionname_ptr
, line_ptr
,
9092 & elf_tdata (abfd
)->dwarf2_find_line_info
);
9097 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd
*abfd
, struct bfd_link_info
*info
)
9099 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
9100 int ret
= bed
->s
->sizeof_ehdr
;
9102 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info
))
9104 bfd_size_type phdr_size
= elf_program_header_size (abfd
);
9106 if (phdr_size
== (bfd_size_type
) -1)
9108 struct elf_segment_map
*m
;
9111 for (m
= elf_seg_map (abfd
); m
!= NULL
; m
= m
->next
)
9112 phdr_size
+= bed
->s
->sizeof_phdr
;
9115 phdr_size
= get_program_header_size (abfd
, info
);
9118 elf_program_header_size (abfd
) = phdr_size
;
9126 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd
*abfd
,
9128 const void *location
,
9130 bfd_size_type count
)
9132 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
9135 if (! abfd
->output_has_begun
9136 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd
, NULL
))
9142 hdr
= &elf_section_data (section
)->this_hdr
;
9143 if (hdr
->sh_offset
== (file_ptr
) -1)
9145 if (bfd_section_is_ctf (section
))
9146 /* Nothing to do with this section: the contents are generated
9150 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
9151 unsigned char *contents
= hdr
->contents
;
9152 if ((offset
+ count
) > hdr
->sh_size
9153 || (section
->flags
& SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
) == 0
9154 || contents
== NULL
)
9156 memcpy (contents
+ offset
, location
, count
);
9159 pos
= hdr
->sh_offset
+ offset
;
9160 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, pos
, SEEK_SET
) != 0
9161 || bfd_bwrite (location
, count
, abfd
) != count
)
9168 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9169 arelent
*cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9170 Elf_Internal_Rela
*dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
9176 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
9179 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd
*abfd
, arelent
*areloc
)
9181 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
9183 if ((*areloc
->sym_ptr_ptr
)->the_bfd
->xvec
!= abfd
->xvec
)
9185 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code
;
9186 reloc_howto_type
*howto
;
9188 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
9189 equivalent ELF reloc. */
9191 if (areloc
->howto
->pc_relative
)
9193 switch (areloc
->howto
->bitsize
)
9196 code
= BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL
;
9199 code
= BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL
;
9202 code
= BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL
;
9205 code
= BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL
;
9208 code
= BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL
;
9211 code
= BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL
;
9217 howto
= bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd
, code
);
9219 if (howto
&& areloc
->howto
->pcrel_offset
!= howto
->pcrel_offset
)
9221 if (howto
->pcrel_offset
)
9222 areloc
->addend
+= areloc
->address
;
9224 areloc
->addend
-= areloc
->address
; /* addend is unsigned!! */
9229 switch (areloc
->howto
->bitsize
)
9235 code
= BFD_RELOC_14
;
9238 code
= BFD_RELOC_16
;
9241 code
= BFD_RELOC_26
;
9244 code
= BFD_RELOC_32
;
9247 code
= BFD_RELOC_64
;
9253 howto
= bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd
, code
);
9257 areloc
->howto
= howto
;
9265 /* xgettext:c-format */
9266 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
9267 abfd
, areloc
->howto
->name
);
9268 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry
);
9273 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd
*abfd
)
9275 struct elf_obj_tdata
*tdata
= elf_tdata (abfd
);
9276 if (bfd_get_format (abfd
) == bfd_object
&& tdata
!= NULL
)
9278 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->o
!= NULL
&& elf_shstrtab (abfd
) != NULL
)
9279 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd
));
9280 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd
, &tdata
->dwarf2_find_line_info
);
9283 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd
);
9286 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9287 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9288 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9291 bfd_reloc_status_type
9292 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9293 (bfd
*abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, arelent
*re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9294 struct bfd_symbol
*symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9295 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, asection
*is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
9296 bfd
*obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
9298 return bfd_reloc_ok
;
9301 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9302 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9303 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9304 out details about the corefile. */
9306 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9307 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
9308 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
9309 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9312 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9313 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9316 elfcore_make_pid (bfd
*abfd
)
9320 pid
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
;
9322 pid
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
;
9327 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9328 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9329 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9333 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd
*abfd
, char *name
, asection
*sect
)
9337 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, name
) != NULL
)
9340 sect2
= bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd
, name
, sect
->flags
);
9344 sect2
->size
= sect
->size
;
9345 sect2
->filepos
= sect
->filepos
;
9346 sect2
->alignment_power
= sect
->alignment_power
;
9350 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9351 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9352 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9353 such a section already exists.
9354 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9355 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9356 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9358 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd
*abfd
,
9364 char *threaded_name
;
9368 /* Build the section name. */
9370 sprintf (buf
, "%s/%d", name
, elfcore_make_pid (abfd
));
9371 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
9372 threaded_name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
9373 if (threaded_name
== NULL
)
9375 memcpy (threaded_name
, buf
, len
);
9377 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, threaded_name
,
9382 sect
->filepos
= filepos
;
9383 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
9385 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, name
, sect
);
9389 elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
,
9392 asection
*sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, ".auxv",
9398 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
- offs
;
9399 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
+ offs
;
9400 sect
->alignment_power
= 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd
) / 32;
9405 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9407 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9411 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9414 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9419 if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (prstatus_t
))
9423 size
= sizeof (prstat
.pr_reg
);
9424 offset
= offsetof (prstatus_t
, pr_reg
);
9425 memcpy (&prstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (prstat
));
9427 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9428 has already been set by another thread. */
9429 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
== 0)
9430 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= prstat
.pr_cursig
;
9431 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
== 0)
9432 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= prstat
.pr_pid
;
9434 /* pr_who exists on:
9437 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9440 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9441 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= prstat
.pr_who
;
9443 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= prstat
.pr_pid
;
9446 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9447 else if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (prstatus32_t
))
9449 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9450 prstatus32_t prstat
;
9452 size
= sizeof (prstat
.pr_reg
);
9453 offset
= offsetof (prstatus32_t
, pr_reg
);
9454 memcpy (&prstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (prstat
));
9456 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9457 has already been set by another thread. */
9458 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
== 0)
9459 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= prstat
.pr_cursig
;
9460 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
== 0)
9461 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= prstat
.pr_pid
;
9463 /* pr_who exists on:
9466 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9469 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9470 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= prstat
.pr_who
;
9472 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= prstat
.pr_pid
;
9475 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9478 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9479 note size (ie. data object type). */
9483 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9484 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg",
9485 size
, note
->descpos
+ offset
);
9487 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9489 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9491 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd
*abfd
,
9493 Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9495 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd
, name
,
9496 note
->descsz
, note
->descpos
);
9499 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9500 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9501 data structure apart. */
9504 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9506 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
9509 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9510 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9514 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9516 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-xfp", note
);
9519 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9520 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9521 contents literally. */
9524 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9526 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-xstate", note
);
9530 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9532 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note
);
9536 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9538 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note
);
9542 elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9544 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tar", note
);
9548 elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9550 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note
);
9554 elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9556 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note
);
9560 elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9562 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note
);
9566 elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9568 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note
);
9572 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9574 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note
);
9578 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9580 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note
);
9584 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9586 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note
);
9590 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9592 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note
);
9596 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9598 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note
);
9602 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9604 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note
);
9608 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9610 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note
);
9614 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9616 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note
);
9620 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9622 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note
);
9626 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9628 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-timer", note
);
9632 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9634 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note
);
9638 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9640 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note
);
9644 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9646 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note
);
9650 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9652 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-prefix", note
);
9656 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9658 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-last-break", note
);
9662 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9664 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-system-call", note
);
9668 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9670 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-tdb", note
);
9674 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9676 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note
);
9680 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9682 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note
);
9686 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9688 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note
);
9692 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9694 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note
);
9698 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9700 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-arm-vfp", note
);
9704 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9706 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-tls", note
);
9710 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9712 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note
);
9716 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9718 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note
);
9722 elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9724 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-sve", note
);
9728 elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9730 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-aarch-pauth", note
);
9733 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9734 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t
;
9735 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9736 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t
;
9740 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9741 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t
;
9742 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9743 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t
;
9747 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9748 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9749 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9752 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd
*abfd
, char *start
, size_t max
)
9755 char *end
= (char *) memchr (start
, '\0', max
);
9763 dups
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
+ 1);
9767 memcpy (dups
, start
, len
);
9773 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9775 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9777 if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t
))
9779 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo
;
9781 memcpy (&psinfo
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (psinfo
));
9783 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9784 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= psinfo
.pr_pid
;
9786 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->program
9787 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, psinfo
.pr_fname
,
9788 sizeof (psinfo
.pr_fname
));
9790 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
9791 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, psinfo
.pr_psargs
,
9792 sizeof (psinfo
.pr_psargs
));
9794 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9795 else if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t
))
9797 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9798 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo
;
9800 memcpy (&psinfo
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (psinfo
));
9802 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9803 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= psinfo
.pr_pid
;
9805 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->program
9806 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, psinfo
.pr_fname
,
9807 sizeof (psinfo
.pr_fname
));
9809 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
9810 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, psinfo
.pr_psargs
,
9811 sizeof (psinfo
.pr_psargs
));
9817 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9818 note size (ie. data object type). */
9822 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9823 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9824 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9827 char *command
= elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
;
9828 int n
= strlen (command
);
9830 if (0 < n
&& command
[n
- 1] == ' ')
9831 command
[n
- 1] = '\0';
9836 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9838 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9840 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9842 if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (pstatus_t
)
9843 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9844 || note
->descsz
== sizeof (pxstatus_t
)
9850 memcpy (&pstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (pstat
));
9852 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= pstat
.pr_pid
;
9854 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9855 else if (note
->descsz
== sizeof (pstatus32_t
))
9857 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9860 memcpy (&pstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (pstat
));
9862 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= pstat
.pr_pid
;
9865 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9866 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9867 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9871 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9873 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9875 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9877 lwpstatus_t lwpstat
;
9883 if (note
->descsz
!= sizeof (lwpstat
)
9884 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9885 && note
->descsz
!= sizeof (lwpxstatus_t
)
9890 memcpy (&lwpstat
, note
->descdata
, sizeof (lwpstat
));
9892 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= lwpstat
.pr_lwpid
;
9893 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9895 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
== 0)
9896 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= lwpstat
.pr_cursig
;
9898 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9900 sprintf (buf
, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd
));
9901 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
9902 name
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
9905 memcpy (name
, buf
, len
);
9907 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
9911 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9912 sect
->size
= sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.gregs
);
9913 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
9914 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t
, pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.gregs
);
9917 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9918 sect
->size
= sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_reg
);
9919 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
+ offsetof (lwpstatus_t
, pr_reg
);
9922 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
9924 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, ".reg", sect
))
9927 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9929 sprintf (buf
, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd
));
9930 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
9931 name
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
9934 memcpy (name
, buf
, len
);
9936 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
9940 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9941 sect
->size
= sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.fpregs
);
9942 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
9943 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t
, pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.fpregs
);
9946 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9947 sect
->size
= sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_fpreg
);
9948 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
+ offsetof (lwpstatus_t
, pr_fpreg
);
9951 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
9953 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, ".reg2", sect
);
9955 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9958 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
9965 int is_active_thread
;
9968 if (note
->descsz
< 728)
9971 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note
->namedata
, "win32"))
9974 type
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
);
9978 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9979 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9980 /* process_info.pid */
9981 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 8);
9982 /* process_info.signal */
9983 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 12);
9986 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9987 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9988 /* thread_info.tid */
9989 sprintf (buf
, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 8));
9991 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
9992 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
9996 memcpy (name
, buf
, len
);
9998 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10002 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10004 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10005 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
+ 12;
10006 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
10008 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
10009 is_active_thread
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 8);
10011 if (is_active_thread
)
10012 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, ".reg", sect
))
10016 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
10017 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
10018 /* module_info.base_address */
10019 base_addr
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 4);
10020 sprintf (buf
, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr
);
10022 len
= strlen (buf
) + 1;
10023 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
10027 memcpy (name
, buf
, len
);
10029 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10034 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
10035 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
10036 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
10047 elfcore_grok_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10049 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
10051 switch (note
->type
)
10057 if (bed
->elf_backend_grok_prstatus
)
10058 if ((*bed
->elf_backend_grok_prstatus
) (abfd
, note
))
10060 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10061 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd
, note
);
10066 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10068 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd
, note
);
10071 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10073 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd
, note
);
10076 case NT_FPREGSET
: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
10077 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd
, note
);
10079 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS
:
10080 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd
, note
);
10082 case NT_PRXFPREG
: /* Linux SSE extension */
10083 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10084 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10085 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd
, note
);
10089 case NT_X86_XSTATE
: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
10090 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10091 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10092 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd
, note
);
10097 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10098 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10099 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd
, note
);
10104 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10105 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10106 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd
, note
);
10111 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10112 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10113 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd
, note
);
10118 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10119 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10120 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd
, note
);
10125 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10126 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10127 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd
, note
);
10132 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10133 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10134 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd
, note
);
10139 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10140 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10141 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd
, note
);
10145 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR
:
10146 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10147 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10148 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd
, note
);
10152 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR
:
10153 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10154 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10155 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd
, note
);
10159 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX
:
10160 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10161 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10162 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd
, note
);
10166 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX
:
10167 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10168 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10169 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd
, note
);
10173 case NT_PPC_TM_SPR
:
10174 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10175 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10176 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd
, note
);
10180 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR
:
10181 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10182 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10183 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd
, note
);
10187 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR
:
10188 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10189 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10190 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd
, note
);
10194 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR
:
10195 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10196 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10197 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd
, note
);
10201 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS
:
10202 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10203 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10204 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd
, note
);
10208 case NT_S390_TIMER
:
10209 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10210 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10211 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd
, note
);
10215 case NT_S390_TODCMP
:
10216 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10217 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10218 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd
, note
);
10222 case NT_S390_TODPREG
:
10223 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10224 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10225 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd
, note
);
10230 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10231 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10232 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd
, note
);
10236 case NT_S390_PREFIX
:
10237 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10238 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10239 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd
, note
);
10243 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK
:
10244 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10245 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10246 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd
, note
);
10250 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL
:
10251 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10252 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10253 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd
, note
);
10258 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10259 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10260 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd
, note
);
10264 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW
:
10265 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10266 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10267 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd
, note
);
10271 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH
:
10272 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10273 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10274 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd
, note
);
10278 case NT_S390_GS_CB
:
10279 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10280 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10281 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd
, note
);
10285 case NT_S390_GS_BC
:
10286 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10287 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10288 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd
, note
);
10293 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10294 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10295 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd
, note
);
10300 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10301 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10302 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd
, note
);
10306 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK
:
10307 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10308 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10309 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd
, note
);
10313 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH
:
10314 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10315 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10316 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd
, note
);
10321 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10322 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10323 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd
, note
);
10327 case NT_ARM_PAC_MASK
:
10328 if (note
->namesz
== 6
10329 && strcmp (note
->namedata
, "LINUX") == 0)
10330 return elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (abfd
, note
);
10336 if (bed
->elf_backend_grok_psinfo
)
10337 if ((*bed
->elf_backend_grok_psinfo
) (abfd
, note
))
10339 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10340 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd
, note
);
10346 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd
, note
, 0);
10349 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10353 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10360 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10362 struct bfd_build_id
* build_id
;
10364 if (note
->descsz
== 0)
10367 build_id
= bfd_alloc (abfd
, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id
) - 1 + note
->descsz
);
10368 if (build_id
== NULL
)
10371 build_id
->size
= note
->descsz
;
10372 memcpy (build_id
->data
, note
->descdata
, note
->descsz
);
10373 abfd
->build_id
= build_id
;
10379 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10381 switch (note
->type
)
10386 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0
:
10387 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd
, note
);
10389 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID
:
10390 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd
, note
);
10395 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10397 struct sdt_note
*cur
=
10398 (struct sdt_note
*) bfd_alloc (abfd
,
10399 sizeof (struct sdt_note
) + note
->descsz
);
10401 cur
->next
= (struct sdt_note
*) (elf_tdata (abfd
))->sdt_note_head
;
10402 cur
->size
= (bfd_size_type
) note
->descsz
;
10403 memcpy (cur
->data
, note
->descdata
, note
->descsz
);
10405 elf_tdata (abfd
)->sdt_note_head
= cur
;
10411 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10413 switch (note
->type
)
10416 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd
, note
);
10424 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10428 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
])
10431 if (note
->descsz
< 108)
10436 if (note
->descsz
< 120)
10444 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10445 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
) != 1)
10450 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10451 if (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
] == ELFCLASS32
)
10455 offset
+= 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10459 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10460 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->program
10461 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ offset
, 17);
10464 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10465 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
10466 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ offset
, 81);
10469 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10472 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10473 if (note
->descsz
< offset
+ 4)
10476 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
10477 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10483 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10489 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10490 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10491 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
])
10495 min_size
= offset
+ (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10499 offset
= 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10500 min_size
= offset
+ (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10507 if (note
->descsz
< min_size
)
10510 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10511 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
) != 1)
10514 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10515 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10516 if (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
] == ELFCLASS32
)
10518 size
= bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10523 size
= bfd_h_get_64 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10527 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10530 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10531 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
== 0)
10532 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
10533 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10536 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10537 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
10538 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ offset
);
10541 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10542 if (elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_ident
[EI_CLASS
] == ELFCLASS64
)
10545 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10546 if ((note
->descsz
- offset
) < size
)
10549 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10550 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg",
10551 size
, note
->descpos
+ offset
);
10555 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10557 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
10559 switch (note
->type
)
10562 if (bed
->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus
)
10563 if ((*bed
->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus
) (abfd
, note
))
10565 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd
, note
);
10568 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd
, note
);
10571 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd
, note
);
10573 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC
:
10574 if (note
->namesz
== 8)
10575 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".thrmisc", note
);
10579 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC
:
10580 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10583 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES
:
10584 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10587 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP
:
10588 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10591 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV
:
10592 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd
, note
, 4);
10594 case NT_X86_XSTATE
:
10595 if (note
->namesz
== 8)
10596 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd
, note
);
10600 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO
:
10601 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10605 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd
, note
);
10613 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note
*note
, int *lwpidp
)
10617 cp
= strchr (note
->namedata
, '@');
10620 *lwpidp
= atoi(cp
+ 1);
10627 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10629 if (note
->descsz
<= 0x7c + 31)
10632 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10633 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
10634 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ 0x08);
10636 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10637 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
10638 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ 0x50);
10640 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10641 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
10642 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 0x7c, 31);
10644 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10649 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10653 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note
, &lwp
))
10654 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= lwp
;
10656 switch (note
->type
)
10658 case NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO
:
10659 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10660 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10661 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10662 creates a core file. */
10663 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd
, note
);
10664 #ifdef NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV
10665 case NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV
:
10666 /* NetBSD-specific Elf Auxiliary Vector data. */
10667 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd
, note
, 4);
10673 /* As of March 2017 there are no other machine-independent notes
10674 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10675 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10678 if (note
->type
< NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
)
10682 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd
))
10684 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10685 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10687 case bfd_arch_alpha
:
10688 case bfd_arch_sparc
:
10689 switch (note
->type
)
10691 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+0:
10692 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg", note
);
10694 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+2:
10695 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
10701 /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
10702 There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
10703 structure which lacks GBR. */
10706 switch (note
->type
)
10708 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+3:
10709 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg", note
);
10711 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+5:
10712 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
10718 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10719 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10722 switch (note
->type
)
10724 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+1:
10725 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg", note
);
10727 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH
+3:
10728 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
10738 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10740 if (note
->descsz
<= 0x48 + 31)
10743 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10744 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
10745 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ 0x08);
10747 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10748 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
10749 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) note
->descdata
+ 0x20);
10751 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10752 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->command
10753 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd
, note
->descdata
+ 0x48, 31);
10759 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10761 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO
)
10762 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd
, note
);
10764 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_REGS
)
10765 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg", note
);
10767 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS
)
10768 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg2", note
);
10770 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS
)
10771 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".reg-xfp", note
);
10773 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_AUXV
)
10774 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd
, note
, 0);
10776 if (note
->type
== NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE
)
10778 asection
*sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, ".wcookie",
10783 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
10784 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
10785 sect
->alignment_power
= 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd
) / 32;
10794 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
, long *tid
)
10796 void *ddata
= note
->descdata
;
10803 if (note
->descsz
< 16)
10806 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10807 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->pid
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) ddata
);
10809 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10810 *tid
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) ddata
+ 4);
10812 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10813 flags
= bfd_get_32 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) ddata
+ 8);
10815 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10816 if ((sig
= bfd_get_16 (abfd
, (bfd_byte
*) ddata
+ 14)) > 0)
10818 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->signal
= sig
;
10819 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= *tid
;
10822 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10823 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10824 thread just in case. */
10825 if (flags
& 0x00000080)
10826 elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
= *tid
;
10828 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10829 sprintf (buf
, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid
);
10831 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, strlen (buf
) + 1);
10834 strcpy (name
, buf
);
10836 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10840 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
10841 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
10842 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
10844 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, ".qnx_core_status", sect
));
10848 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd
*abfd
,
10849 Elf_Internal_Note
*note
,
10857 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10858 sprintf (buf
, "%s/%ld", base
, tid
);
10860 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, strlen (buf
) + 1);
10863 strcpy (name
, buf
);
10865 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10869 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
10870 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
10871 sect
->alignment_power
= 2;
10873 /* This is the current thread. */
10874 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->core
->lwpid
== tid
)
10875 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd
, base
, sect
);
10880 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10881 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10882 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10883 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10886 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10888 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10889 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10891 static long tid
= 1;
10893 switch (note
->type
)
10895 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO
:
10896 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd
, ".qnx_core_info", note
);
10897 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS
:
10898 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd
, note
, &tid
);
10899 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG
:
10900 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd
, note
, tid
, ".reg");
10901 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG
:
10902 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd
, note
, tid
, ".reg2");
10909 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd
*abfd
, Elf_Internal_Note
*note
)
10915 /* Use note name as section name. */
10916 len
= note
->namesz
;
10917 name
= (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd
, len
);
10920 memcpy (name
, note
->namedata
, len
);
10921 name
[len
- 1] = '\0';
10923 sect
= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd
, name
, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
);
10927 sect
->size
= note
->descsz
;
10928 sect
->filepos
= note
->descpos
;
10929 sect
->alignment_power
= 1;
10934 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10937 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10941 size of data for note
10943 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10944 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10945 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10946 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10949 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10952 elfcore_write_note (bfd
*abfd
,
10960 Elf_External_Note
*xnp
;
10967 namesz
= strlen (name
) + 1;
10969 newspace
= 12 + ((namesz
+ 3) & -4) + ((size
+ 3) & -4);
10971 buf
= (char *) realloc (buf
, *bufsiz
+ newspace
);
10974 dest
= buf
+ *bufsiz
;
10975 *bufsiz
+= newspace
;
10976 xnp
= (Elf_External_Note
*) dest
;
10977 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, namesz
, xnp
->namesz
);
10978 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, size
, xnp
->descsz
);
10979 H_PUT_32 (abfd
, type
, xnp
->type
);
10983 memcpy (dest
, name
, namesz
);
10991 memcpy (dest
, input
, size
);
11001 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
11002 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
11003 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
11004 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
11005 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
11006 be NULL terminated.
11007 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
11008 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
11009 the finer control available with later versions.
11010 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
11011 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
11012 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
11013 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
11014 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11015 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
11016 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
11019 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd
*abfd
,
11023 const char *psargs
)
11025 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
11027 if (bed
->elf_backend_write_core_note
!= NULL
)
11030 ret
= (*bed
->elf_backend_write_core_note
) (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11031 NT_PRPSINFO
, fname
, psargs
);
11036 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11037 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11038 if (bed
->s
->elfclass
== ELFCLASS32
)
11040 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11042 int note_type
= NT_PSINFO
;
11045 int note_type
= NT_PRPSINFO
;
11048 memset (&data
, 0, sizeof (data
));
11049 strncpy (data
.pr_fname
, fname
, sizeof (data
.pr_fname
));
11050 strncpy (data
.pr_psargs
, psargs
, sizeof (data
.pr_psargs
));
11051 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11052 "CORE", note_type
, &data
, sizeof (data
));
11057 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11059 int note_type
= NT_PSINFO
;
11062 int note_type
= NT_PRPSINFO
;
11065 memset (&data
, 0, sizeof (data
));
11066 strncpy (data
.pr_fname
, fname
, sizeof (data
.pr_fname
));
11067 strncpy (data
.pr_psargs
, psargs
, sizeof (data
.pr_psargs
));
11068 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11069 "CORE", note_type
, &data
, sizeof (data
));
11071 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
11076 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11077 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
11081 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
11082 (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, int *bufsiz
,
11083 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo
*prpsinfo
)
11085 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16
)
11087 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data
;
11089 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd
, prpsinfo
, &data
);
11090 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO
,
11091 &data
, sizeof (data
));
11095 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data
;
11097 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd
, prpsinfo
, &data
);
11098 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO
,
11099 &data
, sizeof (data
));
11104 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
11105 (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, int *bufsiz
,
11106 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo
*prpsinfo
)
11108 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16
)
11110 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data
;
11112 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd
, prpsinfo
, &data
);
11113 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11114 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO
, &data
, sizeof (data
));
11118 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data
;
11120 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd
, prpsinfo
, &data
);
11121 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11122 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO
, &data
, sizeof (data
));
11127 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd
*abfd
,
11134 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
11136 if (bed
->elf_backend_write_core_note
!= NULL
)
11139 ret
= (*bed
->elf_backend_write_core_note
) (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11141 pid
, cursig
, gregs
);
11146 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
11147 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
11148 if (bed
->s
->elfclass
== ELFCLASS32
)
11150 prstatus32_t prstat
;
11152 memset (&prstat
, 0, sizeof (prstat
));
11153 prstat
.pr_pid
= pid
;
11154 prstat
.pr_cursig
= cursig
;
11155 memcpy (&prstat
.pr_reg
, gregs
, sizeof (prstat
.pr_reg
));
11156 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, "CORE",
11157 NT_PRSTATUS
, &prstat
, sizeof (prstat
));
11164 memset (&prstat
, 0, sizeof (prstat
));
11165 prstat
.pr_pid
= pid
;
11166 prstat
.pr_cursig
= cursig
;
11167 memcpy (&prstat
.pr_reg
, gregs
, sizeof (prstat
.pr_reg
));
11168 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, "CORE",
11169 NT_PRSTATUS
, &prstat
, sizeof (prstat
));
11171 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
11177 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
11179 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd
*abfd
,
11186 lwpstatus_t lwpstat
;
11187 const char *note_name
= "CORE";
11189 memset (&lwpstat
, 0, sizeof (lwpstat
));
11190 lwpstat
.pr_lwpid
= pid
>> 16;
11191 lwpstat
.pr_cursig
= cursig
;
11192 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
11193 memcpy (&lwpstat
.pr_reg
, gregs
, sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_reg
));
11194 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
11195 #if !defined(gregs)
11196 memcpy (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.gregs
,
11197 gregs
, sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.gregs
));
11199 memcpy (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.__gregs
,
11200 gregs
, sizeof (lwpstat
.pr_context
.uc_mcontext
.__gregs
));
11203 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, note_name
,
11204 NT_LWPSTATUS
, &lwpstat
, sizeof (lwpstat
));
11206 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
11208 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
11210 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd
*abfd
,
11214 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
11215 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
11217 const char *note_name
= "CORE";
11218 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
11219 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
11221 if (bed
->s
->elfclass
== ELFCLASS32
)
11225 memset (&pstat
, 0, sizeof (pstat
));
11226 pstat
.pr_pid
= pid
& 0xffff;
11227 buf
= elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, note_name
,
11228 NT_PSTATUS
, &pstat
, sizeof (pstat
));
11236 memset (&pstat
, 0, sizeof (pstat
));
11237 pstat
.pr_pid
= pid
& 0xffff;
11238 buf
= elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, note_name
,
11239 NT_PSTATUS
, &pstat
, sizeof (pstat
));
11243 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
11246 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd
*abfd
,
11249 const void *fpregs
,
11252 const char *note_name
= "CORE";
11253 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11254 note_name
, NT_FPREGSET
, fpregs
, size
);
11258 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd
*abfd
,
11261 const void *xfpregs
,
11264 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11265 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11266 note_name
, NT_PRXFPREG
, xfpregs
, size
);
11270 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, int *bufsiz
,
11271 const void *xfpregs
, int size
)
11274 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->elf_osabi
== ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
)
11275 note_name
= "FreeBSD";
11277 note_name
= "LINUX";
11278 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11279 note_name
, NT_X86_XSTATE
, xfpregs
, size
);
11283 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd
*abfd
,
11286 const void *ppc_vmx
,
11289 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11290 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11291 note_name
, NT_PPC_VMX
, ppc_vmx
, size
);
11295 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd
*abfd
,
11298 const void *ppc_vsx
,
11301 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11302 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11303 note_name
, NT_PPC_VSX
, ppc_vsx
, size
);
11307 elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd
*abfd
,
11310 const void *ppc_tar
,
11313 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11314 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11315 note_name
, NT_PPC_TAR
, ppc_tar
, size
);
11319 elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd
*abfd
,
11322 const void *ppc_ppr
,
11325 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11326 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11327 note_name
, NT_PPC_PPR
, ppc_ppr
, size
);
11331 elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd
*abfd
,
11334 const void *ppc_dscr
,
11337 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11338 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11339 note_name
, NT_PPC_DSCR
, ppc_dscr
, size
);
11343 elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd
*abfd
,
11346 const void *ppc_ebb
,
11349 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11350 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11351 note_name
, NT_PPC_EBB
, ppc_ebb
, size
);
11355 elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd
*abfd
,
11358 const void *ppc_pmu
,
11361 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11362 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11363 note_name
, NT_PPC_PMU
, ppc_pmu
, size
);
11367 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd
*abfd
,
11370 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr
,
11373 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11374 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11375 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR
, ppc_tm_cgpr
, size
);
11379 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd
*abfd
,
11382 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr
,
11385 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11386 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11387 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR
, ppc_tm_cfpr
, size
);
11391 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd
*abfd
,
11394 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx
,
11397 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11398 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11399 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX
, ppc_tm_cvmx
, size
);
11403 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd
*abfd
,
11406 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx
,
11409 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11410 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11411 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX
, ppc_tm_cvsx
, size
);
11415 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd
*abfd
,
11418 const void *ppc_tm_spr
,
11421 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11422 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11423 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_SPR
, ppc_tm_spr
, size
);
11427 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd
*abfd
,
11430 const void *ppc_tm_ctar
,
11433 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11434 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11435 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR
, ppc_tm_ctar
, size
);
11439 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd
*abfd
,
11442 const void *ppc_tm_cppr
,
11445 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11446 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11447 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR
, ppc_tm_cppr
, size
);
11451 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd
*abfd
,
11454 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr
,
11457 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11458 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11459 note_name
, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR
, ppc_tm_cdscr
, size
);
11463 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd
*abfd
,
11466 const void *s390_high_gprs
,
11469 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11470 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11471 note_name
, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS
,
11472 s390_high_gprs
, size
);
11476 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd
*abfd
,
11479 const void *s390_timer
,
11482 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11483 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11484 note_name
, NT_S390_TIMER
, s390_timer
, size
);
11488 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd
*abfd
,
11491 const void *s390_todcmp
,
11494 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11495 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11496 note_name
, NT_S390_TODCMP
, s390_todcmp
, size
);
11500 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd
*abfd
,
11503 const void *s390_todpreg
,
11506 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11507 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11508 note_name
, NT_S390_TODPREG
, s390_todpreg
, size
);
11512 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd
*abfd
,
11515 const void *s390_ctrs
,
11518 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11519 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11520 note_name
, NT_S390_CTRS
, s390_ctrs
, size
);
11524 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd
*abfd
,
11527 const void *s390_prefix
,
11530 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11531 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11532 note_name
, NT_S390_PREFIX
, s390_prefix
, size
);
11536 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd
*abfd
,
11539 const void *s390_last_break
,
11542 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11543 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11544 note_name
, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK
,
11545 s390_last_break
, size
);
11549 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd
*abfd
,
11552 const void *s390_system_call
,
11555 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11556 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11557 note_name
, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL
,
11558 s390_system_call
, size
);
11562 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd
*abfd
,
11565 const void *s390_tdb
,
11568 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11569 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11570 note_name
, NT_S390_TDB
, s390_tdb
, size
);
11574 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd
*abfd
,
11577 const void *s390_vxrs_low
,
11580 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11581 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11582 note_name
, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW
, s390_vxrs_low
, size
);
11586 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd
*abfd
,
11589 const void *s390_vxrs_high
,
11592 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11593 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11594 note_name
, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH
,
11595 s390_vxrs_high
, size
);
11599 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd
*abfd
,
11602 const void *s390_gs_cb
,
11605 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11606 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11607 note_name
, NT_S390_GS_CB
,
11612 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd
*abfd
,
11615 const void *s390_gs_bc
,
11618 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11619 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11620 note_name
, NT_S390_GS_BC
,
11625 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd
*abfd
,
11628 const void *arm_vfp
,
11631 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11632 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11633 note_name
, NT_ARM_VFP
, arm_vfp
, size
);
11637 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd
*abfd
,
11640 const void *aarch_tls
,
11643 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11644 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11645 note_name
, NT_ARM_TLS
, aarch_tls
, size
);
11649 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd
*abfd
,
11652 const void *aarch_hw_break
,
11655 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11656 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11657 note_name
, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK
, aarch_hw_break
, size
);
11661 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd
*abfd
,
11664 const void *aarch_hw_watch
,
11667 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11668 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11669 note_name
, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH
, aarch_hw_watch
, size
);
11673 elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd
*abfd
,
11676 const void *aarch_sve
,
11679 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11680 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11681 note_name
, NT_ARM_SVE
, aarch_sve
, size
);
11685 elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (bfd
*abfd
,
11688 const void *aarch_pauth
,
11691 char *note_name
= "LINUX";
11692 return elfcore_write_note (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
,
11693 note_name
, NT_ARM_PAC_MASK
, aarch_pauth
, size
);
11697 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd
*abfd
,
11700 const char *section
,
11704 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg2") == 0)
11705 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11706 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11707 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11708 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11709 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11710 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11711 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11712 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11713 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11714 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
11715 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11716 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
11717 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11718 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
11719 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11720 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
11721 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11722 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
11723 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11724 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
11725 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11726 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
11727 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11728 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
11729 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11730 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
11731 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11732 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
11733 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11734 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
11735 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11736 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
11737 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11738 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
11739 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11740 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11741 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11742 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11743 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11744 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11745 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11746 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
11747 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11748 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
11749 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11750 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
11751 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11752 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
11753 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11754 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
11755 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11756 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
11757 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11758 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
11759 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11760 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
11761 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11762 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
11763 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11764 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
11765 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11766 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
11767 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11768 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
11769 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11770 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
11771 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11772 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
11773 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11774 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
11775 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11776 if (strcmp (section
, ".reg-aarch-pauth") == 0)
11777 return elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (abfd
, buf
, bufsiz
, data
, size
);
11782 elf_parse_notes (bfd
*abfd
, char *buf
, size_t size
, file_ptr offset
,
11787 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
11788 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
11789 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
11790 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
11793 if (align
!= 4 && align
!= 8)
11797 while (p
< buf
+ size
)
11799 Elf_External_Note
*xnp
= (Elf_External_Note
*) p
;
11800 Elf_Internal_Note in
;
11802 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note
, name
) > buf
- p
+ size
)
11805 in
.type
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, xnp
->type
);
11807 in
.namesz
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, xnp
->namesz
);
11808 in
.namedata
= xnp
->name
;
11809 if (in
.namesz
> buf
- in
.namedata
+ size
)
11812 in
.descsz
= H_GET_32 (abfd
, xnp
->descsz
);
11813 in
.descdata
= p
+ ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in
.namesz
, align
);
11814 in
.descpos
= offset
+ (in
.descdata
- buf
);
11816 && (in
.descdata
>= buf
+ size
11817 || in
.descsz
> buf
- in
.descdata
+ size
))
11820 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd
))
11827 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11830 const char * string
;
11832 bfd_boolean (* func
)(bfd
*, Elf_Internal_Note
*);
11836 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note
),
11837 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note
),
11838 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note
),
11839 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note
),
11840 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note
),
11841 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note
),
11842 GROKER_ELEMENT ("GNU", elfobj_grok_gnu_note
)
11844 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11847 for (i
= ARRAY_SIZE (grokers
); i
--;)
11849 if (in
.namesz
>= grokers
[i
].len
11850 && strncmp (in
.namedata
, grokers
[i
].string
,
11851 grokers
[i
].len
) == 0)
11853 if (! grokers
[i
].func (abfd
, & in
))
11862 if (in
.namesz
== sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in
.namedata
, "GNU") == 0)
11864 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd
, &in
))
11867 else if (in
.namesz
== sizeof "stapsdt"
11868 && strcmp (in
.namedata
, "stapsdt") == 0)
11870 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd
, &in
))
11876 p
+= ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in
.namesz
, in
.descsz
, align
);
11883 elf_read_notes (bfd
*abfd
, file_ptr offset
, bfd_size_type size
,
11888 if (size
== 0 || (size
+ 1) == 0)
11891 if (bfd_seek (abfd
, offset
, SEEK_SET
) != 0)
11894 buf
= (char *) bfd_malloc (size
+ 1);
11898 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
11899 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
11902 if (bfd_bread (buf
, size
, abfd
) != size
11903 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd
, buf
, size
, offset
, align
))
11913 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
11915 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
11916 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
11917 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11920 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd
*abfd
)
11922 if (abfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
11924 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format
);
11928 return elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
* sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr
);
11931 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
11932 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
11933 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
11934 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
11936 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
11937 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11940 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd
*abfd
, void *phdrs
)
11944 if (abfd
->xvec
->flavour
!= bfd_target_elf_flavour
)
11946 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format
);
11950 num_phdrs
= elf_elfheader (abfd
)->e_phnum
;
11951 if (num_phdrs
!= 0)
11952 memcpy (phdrs
, elf_tdata (abfd
)->phdr
,
11953 num_phdrs
* sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr
));
11958 enum elf_reloc_type_class
11959 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info
*info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
11960 const asection
*rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
11961 const Elf_Internal_Rela
*rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
11963 return reloc_class_normal
;
11966 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
11967 relocation against a local symbol. */
11970 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd
*abfd
,
11971 Elf_Internal_Sym
*sym
,
11973 Elf_Internal_Rela
*rel
)
11975 asection
*sec
= *psec
;
11976 bfd_vma relocation
;
11978 relocation
= (sec
->output_section
->vma
11979 + sec
->output_offset
11981 if ((sec
->flags
& SEC_MERGE
)
11982 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym
->st_info
) == STT_SECTION
11983 && sec
->sec_info_type
== SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE
)
11986 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd
, psec
,
11987 elf_section_data (sec
)->sec_info
,
11988 sym
->st_value
+ rel
->r_addend
);
11991 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11992 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11993 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11994 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11995 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11996 if ((sec
->flags
& SEC_EXCLUDE
) != 0)
11997 sec
->kept_section
= *psec
;
12000 rel
->r_addend
-= relocation
;
12001 rel
->r_addend
+= sec
->output_section
->vma
+ sec
->output_offset
;
12007 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd
*abfd
,
12008 Elf_Internal_Sym
*sym
,
12012 asection
*sec
= *psec
;
12014 if (sec
->sec_info_type
!= SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE
)
12015 return sym
->st_value
+ addend
;
12017 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd
, psec
,
12018 elf_section_data (sec
)->sec_info
,
12019 sym
->st_value
+ addend
);
12022 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
12023 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
12024 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
12025 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
12029 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd
*abfd
,
12030 struct bfd_link_info
*info
,
12034 switch (sec
->sec_info_type
)
12036 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS
:
12037 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec
, elf_section_data (sec
)->sec_info
,
12039 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
:
12040 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd
, info
, sec
, offset
);
12043 if ((sec
->flags
& SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY
) != 0)
12045 /* Reverse the offset. */
12046 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
12047 bfd_size_type address_size
= bed
->s
->arch_size
/ 8;
12049 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
12050 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
12051 offset
= ((sec
->size
- address_size
)
12052 / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd
, sec
) - offset
);
12058 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
12059 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
12060 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
12061 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
12062 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
12063 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
12065 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
12066 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
12067 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
12068 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
12069 the remote memory. */
12072 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
12075 bfd_size_type size
,
12076 bfd_vma
*loadbasep
,
12077 int (*target_read_memory
) (bfd_vma
, bfd_byte
*, bfd_size_type
))
12079 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ
)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory
)
12080 (templ
, ehdr_vma
, size
, loadbasep
, target_read_memory
);
12084 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd
*abfd
,
12085 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
12086 asymbol
**syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
12091 const struct elf_backend_data
*bed
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
);
12094 const char *relplt_name
;
12095 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs
) (bfd
*, asection
*, asymbol
**, bfd_boolean
);
12099 Elf_Internal_Shdr
*hdr
;
12105 if ((abfd
->flags
& (DYNAMIC
| EXEC_P
)) == 0)
12108 if (dynsymcount
<= 0)
12111 if (!bed
->plt_sym_val
)
12114 relplt_name
= bed
->relplt_name
;
12115 if (relplt_name
== NULL
)
12116 relplt_name
= bed
->rela_plts_and_copies_p
? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
12117 relplt
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, relplt_name
);
12118 if (relplt
== NULL
)
12121 hdr
= &elf_section_data (relplt
)->this_hdr
;
12122 if (hdr
->sh_link
!= elf_dynsymtab (abfd
)
12123 || (hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_REL
&& hdr
->sh_type
!= SHT_RELA
))
12126 plt
= bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd
, ".plt");
12130 slurp_relocs
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->s
->slurp_reloc_table
;
12131 if (! (*slurp_relocs
) (abfd
, relplt
, dynsyms
, TRUE
))
12134 count
= relplt
->size
/ hdr
->sh_entsize
;
12135 size
= count
* sizeof (asymbol
);
12136 p
= relplt
->relocation
;
12137 for (i
= 0; i
< count
; i
++, p
+= bed
->s
->int_rels_per_ext_rel
)
12139 size
+= strlen ((*p
->sym_ptr_ptr
)->name
) + sizeof ("@plt");
12140 if (p
->addend
!= 0)
12143 size
+= sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed
->s
->elfclass
== ELFCLASS64
);
12145 size
+= sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
12150 s
= *ret
= (asymbol
*) bfd_malloc (size
);
12154 names
= (char *) (s
+ count
);
12155 p
= relplt
->relocation
;
12157 for (i
= 0; i
< count
; i
++, p
+= bed
->s
->int_rels_per_ext_rel
)
12162 addr
= bed
->plt_sym_val (i
, plt
, p
);
12163 if (addr
== (bfd_vma
) -1)
12166 *s
= **p
->sym_ptr_ptr
;
12167 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
12168 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
12169 if ((s
->flags
& BSF_LOCAL
) == 0)
12170 s
->flags
|= BSF_GLOBAL
;
12171 s
->flags
|= BSF_SYNTHETIC
;
12173 s
->value
= addr
- plt
->vma
;
12176 len
= strlen ((*p
->sym_ptr_ptr
)->name
);
12177 memcpy (names
, (*p
->sym_ptr_ptr
)->name
, len
);
12179 if (p
->addend
!= 0)
12183 memcpy (names
, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
12184 names
+= sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
12185 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd
, buf
, p
->addend
);
12186 for (a
= buf
; *a
== '0'; ++a
)
12189 memcpy (names
, a
, len
);
12192 memcpy (names
, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
12193 names
+= sizeof ("@plt");
12200 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
12201 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
12202 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
12203 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
12204 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section
);
12205 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
12206 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section
, &lcomm_sym
,
12207 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON
);
12210 _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (bfd
*abfd
)
12212 Elf_Internal_Ehdr
*i_ehdrp
; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
12214 i_ehdrp
= elf_elfheader (abfd
);
12216 if (i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] == ELFOSABI_NONE
)
12217 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd
)->elf_osabi
;
12219 /* Set the osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains
12220 SHF_GNU_MBIND sections or symbols of STT_GNU_IFUNC type or
12221 STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
12222 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
!= 0)
12224 if (i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] == ELFOSABI_NONE
)
12225 i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] = ELFOSABI_GNU
;
12226 else if (i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] != ELFOSABI_GNU
12227 && i_ehdrp
->e_ident
[EI_OSABI
] != ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
)
12229 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_mbind
)
12230 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_MBIND section is unsupported"));
12231 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_ifunc
)
12232 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol type STT_GNU_IFUNC is unsupported"));
12233 if (elf_tdata (abfd
)->has_gnu_osabi
& elf_gnu_osabi_unique
)
12234 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol binding STB_GNU_UNIQUE is unsupported"));
12235 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry
);
12243 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
12244 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
12245 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
12248 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type
)
12250 return (type
== STT_FUNC
12251 || type
== STT_GNU_IFUNC
);
12254 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
12255 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
12256 otherwise return zero. */
12259 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol
*sym
, asection
*sec
,
12262 bfd_size_type size
;
12264 if ((sym
->flags
& (BSF_SECTION_SYM
| BSF_FILE
| BSF_OBJECT
12265 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
| BSF_RELC
| BSF_SRELC
)) != 0
12266 || sym
->section
!= sec
)
12269 *code_off
= sym
->value
;
12271 if (!(sym
->flags
& BSF_SYNTHETIC
))
12272 size
= ((elf_symbol_type
*) sym
)->internal_elf_sym
.st_size
;